Teller User Guide
Teller User Guide
14.7.0.0.0
F75188-02
November 2022
Oracle Banking Branch Teller User Guide, 14.7.0.0.0
F75188-02
This software and related documentation are provided under a license agreement containing restrictions on
use and disclosure and are protected by intellectual property laws. Except as expressly permitted in your
license agreement or allowed by law, you may not use, copy, reproduce, translate, broadcast, modify, license,
transmit, distribute, exhibit, perform, publish, or display any part, in any form, or by any means. Reverse
engineering, disassembly, or decompilation of this software, unless required by law for interoperability, is
prohibited.
The information contained herein is subject to change without notice and is not warranted to be error-free. If
you find any errors, please report them to us in writing.
If this is software, software documentation, data (as defined in the Federal Acquisition Regulation), or related
documentation that is delivered to the U.S. Government or anyone licensing it on behalf of the U.S.
Government, then the following notice is applicable:
U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS: Oracle programs (including any operating system, integrated software,
any programs embedded, installed, or activated on delivered hardware, and modifications of such programs)
and Oracle computer documentation or other Oracle data delivered to or accessed by U.S. Government end
users are "commercial computer software," "commercial computer software documentation," or "limited rights
data" pursuant to the applicable Federal Acquisition Regulation and agency-specific supplemental
regulations. As such, the use, reproduction, duplication, release, display, disclosure, modification, preparation
of derivative works, and/or adaptation of i) Oracle programs (including any operating system, integrated
software, any programs embedded, installed, or activated on delivered hardware, and modifications of such
programs), ii) Oracle computer documentation and/or iii) other Oracle data, is subject to the rights and
limitations specified in the license contained in the applicable contract. The terms governing the U.S.
Government's use of Oracle cloud services are defined by the applicable contract for such services. No other
rights are granted to the U.S. Government.
This software or hardware is developed for general use in a variety of information management applications.
It is not developed or intended for use in any inherently dangerous applications, including applications that
may create a risk of personal injury. If you use this software or hardware in dangerous applications, then you
shall be responsible to take all appropriate fail-safe, backup, redundancy, and other measures to ensure its
safe use. Oracle Corporation and its affiliates disclaim any liability for any damages caused by use of this
software or hardware in dangerous applications.
Oracle®, Java, MySQL and NetSuite are registered trademarks of Oracle and/or its affiliates. Other names
may be trademarks of their respective owners.
Intel and Intel Inside are trademarks or registered trademarks of Intel Corporation. All SPARC trademarks are
used under license and are trademarks or registered trademarks of SPARC International, Inc. AMD, Epyc,
and the AMD logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Advanced Micro Devices. UNIX is a registered
trademark of The Open Group.
This software or hardware and documentation may provide access to or information about content, products,
and services from third parties. Oracle Corporation and its affiliates are not responsible for and expressly
disclaim all warranties of any kind with respect to third-party content, products, and services unless otherwise
set forth in an applicable agreement between you and Oracle. Oracle Corporation and its affiliates will not be
responsible for any loss, costs, or damages incurred due to your access to or use of third-party content,
products, or services, except as set forth in an applicable agreement between you and Oracle.
Contents
2 Branch Operations
2.1 TC Denomination Enquiry 2-2
2.2 Open Branch Batch 2-3
2.3 Open Vault Batch 2-4
2.4 Open Teller Batch 2-6
2.5 Current Open Tills 2-8
2.6 Branch Breach Limits 2-10
2.7 Till Vault Position 2-11
2.8 Branch Total Position 2-12
2.9 Close Teller Batch 2-14
2.9.1 Add TC Denomination Details 2-16
2.10 Close Vault Batch 2-18
2.11 Close Branch Batch 2-20
2.12 Book Shortage 2-21
2.12.1 Add Denomination Details 2-23
2.13 Book Overage 2-24
2.14 Teller Session 2-26
2.14.1 Start Teller Session 2-26
iii
2.14.2 Stop Teller Session 2-28
3 Till-Vault Operations
3.1 Buy TC from Agent 3-2
3.1.1 Add TC Denominations to Buy TC 3-3
3.2 Buy TC from Head Office 3-4
3.3 Buy TC from Vault 3-5
3.4 Return TC to Vault 3-8
3.4.1 Add TC Denominations to Return TC 3-9
3.5 Return TC to HO 3-10
3.6 Buy Cash from Currency Chest 3-11
3.7 Sell Cash to Currency Chest 3-13
3.8 Buy Cash from Vault 3-14
3.9 Sell Cash to Vault 3-15
3.10 Buy Cash from Till 3-17
3.11 Sell Cash to Till 3-18
3.12 Denomination Exchange 3-20
3.13 Inter Branch Transactions 3-21
3.13.1 Inter Branch Transaction Request 3-22
3.13.2 Inter Branch Transaction Input 3-24
3.13.3 Inter Branch Transaction Liquidation 3-26
4 Customer Transactions
4.1 Cash Deposit 4-2
4.1.1 Add Charge Details 4-6
4.2 Cash Withdrawal 4-7
4.3 Cheque Withdrawal 4-11
4.4 FX Sale Against Account 4-14
4.5 FX Sale Against Walk-in 4-18
4.6 FX Purchase Against Account 4-21
4.7 FX Purchase Against Walk-in 4-25
4.8 Close Out Withdrawal 4-28
4.9 Close Out Withdrawal by Multi-Mode 4-35
4.10 Safe Deposit Rental By Cash 4-38
4.11 Recurring Deposit Payment by Cash 4-41
4.12 F23C Tax Payment by Cash 4-43
4.13 F24C Tax Payment By Cash 4-47
4.13.1 Add Standard Details 4-50
4.13.1.1 Add Tax Details 4-51
iv
4.13.1.2 Add INPS Details 4-52
4.13.1.3 Add Region Details 4-53
4.13.1.4 Add IMU and Other Local Taxes 4-54
4.13.1.5 Add Insurance Details 4-55
4.13.1.6 Add Other Bodies 4-56
4.13.1.7 Add Excise Details 4-57
4.13.2 Add Simplified Details 4-58
4.13.3 Add Element Identification Details 4-60
4.13.4 Add Predefined Details 4-62
4.14 F23 Tax Payment by Account 4-64
4.15 F24 Tax Payment By Account 4-69
4.15.1 Add Standard Details 4-72
4.15.2 Add Simplified Details 4-75
4.15.3 Add Element Identification Details 4-77
4.15.4 Add Predefined Details 4-78
5 Miscellaneous Transactions
5.1 Miscellaneous Customer Debit 5-1
5.2 Miscellaneous Customer Credit 5-4
5.3 Miscellaneous GL Debit 5-8
5.4 Miscellaneous GL Credit 5-10
5.5 Miscellaneous GL Transfer 5-13
5.6 Miscellaneous Transfer 5-16
6 Transfers
6.1 Account to Account Transfer 6-1
6.2 In-House Cheque Deposit 6-5
6.3 Domestic Transfer Against Account 6-8
6.3.1 Add Payment Details for Domestic Transfer 6-10
6.4 Domestic Transfer Against Walk-in 6-12
6.5 International Transfer Against Account 6-14
6.5.1 Add Payment Details for International Transfer 6-18
6.6 International Transfer Against Walk-in 6-21
7 Clearing Transactions
7.1 Cheque Deposit 7-1
7.1.1 Cheque Deposit Against Account 7-1
7.1.2 Cheque Deposit Against GL 7-5
7.2 Cheque Return 7-8
v
7.3 Inward Clearing Data Entry 7-10
7.4 Outward Clearing Data Entry 7-13
8 Remittances
8.1 Banker's Cheque 8-1
8.1.1 BC Issue Against Account 8-2
8.1.2 BC Issue Against Walk-in 8-6
8.1.3 BC Issue Against GL 8-10
8.1.4 BC Print and Reprint 8-14
8.1.5 BC Operations 8-15
8.1.5.1 BC Inquiry 8-16
8.1.5.2 BC Revalidation 8-19
8.1.5.3 BC Duplicate Issue 8-21
8.1.5.4 BC Payment Reversal 8-23
8.1.5.5 BC Payment by Account 8-25
8.1.5.6 BC Payment by Cash 8-27
8.1.5.7 BC Payment by GL 8-30
8.1.5.8 BC Refund by Account 8-32
8.1.5.9 BC Refund by Cash 8-35
8.1.5.10 BC Refund by GL 8-37
8.1.5.11 Cancel BC by Account 8-39
8.1.5.12 Cancel BC by Cash 8-42
8.1.5.13 Cancel BC by GL 8-44
8.1.6 Multi BC Issuance 8-46
8.1.6.1 Multi BC Issuance Against Account 8-47
8.1.6.2 Multi BC Issuance Against Cash 8-50
8.2 Demand Drafts 8-53
8.2.1 DD Issue Against Account 8-54
8.2.2 DD Issue Against Walk-in 8-58
8.2.3 DD Issue Against GL 8-61
8.2.4 DD Print and Reprint 8-65
8.2.5 DD Operations 8-66
8.2.5.1 DD Inquiry 8-67
8.2.5.2 DD Revalidation 8-70
8.2.5.3 DD Duplicate Issue 8-72
8.2.5.4 DD Payment Reversal 8-74
8.2.5.5 DD Payment by Account 8-76
8.2.5.6 DD Payment by Cash 8-79
8.2.5.7 DD Payment by GL 8-81
8.2.5.8 DD Refund by Account 8-84
vi
8.2.5.9 DD Refund by Cash 8-86
8.2.5.10 DD Refund by GL 8-89
8.2.5.11 Cancel DD by Account 8-91
8.2.5.12 Cancel DD by Cash 8-94
8.2.5.13 Cancel DD by GL 8-96
8.3 Cash Remittance 8-98
8.3.1 Cash Remittance Issue 8-99
8.3.1.1 Cash Remittance Issue Against Account 8-99
8.3.1.2 Cash Remittance Issue Against Cash 8-103
8.3.1.3 Cash Remittance Issue Against GL 8-106
8.3.2 Cash Remittance Operations 8-109
8.3.2.1 Cash Remittance Inquiry 8-110
8.3.2.2 Cash Remittance Payment by Account 8-113
8.3.2.3 Cash Remittance Payment by Cash 8-116
8.3.2.4 Cash Remittance Payment by GL 8-118
8.3.2.5 Cash Remittance Refund by Account 8-122
8.3.2.6 Cash Remittance Refund by Cash 8-124
8.3.2.7 Cash Remittance Refund by GL 8-127
8.3.2.8 Cancel Cash Remittance by Account 8-130
8.3.2.9 Cancel Cash Remittance by Cash 8-133
8.3.2.10 Cancel Cash Remittance by GL 8-136
8.3.3 Inward Remittance Registration 8-139
8.4 Travellers Cheque 8-142
8.4.1 TC Sale by Other Modes 8-142
8.4.1.1 Add TC Denominations to Sell TC 8-146
8.4.2 TC Sale Against Walk-in 8-147
8.4.3 TC Purchase Against Account 8-150
8.4.3.1 Add TC Denominations to Purchase TC 8-153
8.4.4 TC Purchase Against Walk-in 8-155
vii
9.5 TD Top-Up Against Cash 9-19
11 Loan Transactions
11.1 Loan Disbursement by Cash 11-1
11.2 Loan Repayment by Cash 11-3
12 Islamic Transactions
12.1 Murabaha Payment by Cash 12-1
12.2 Islamic Down Payment by Cash 12-4
12.3 Islamic TD Account Opening 12-6
12.3.1 Add Funding Details for Islamic TD 12-9
12.3.2 Add Joint Holders for Islamic TD 12-11
12.3.3 Add Payout Details for Islamic TD 12-12
12.3.4 Add Rollover Details for Islamic TD 12-14
13 Bill Payments
13.1 Bill Payment by Cash 13-1
13.2 Bill Payments by Other Modes 13-3
13.2.1 Bill Payment by Account 13-3
13.2.2 Bill Payment by Clearing Cheque 13-6
viii
15 Journal Log
15.1 About Electronic and Servicing Journals 15-1
15.2 Electronic Journal 15-3
15.3 Servicing Journal 15-7
15.4 Reassign Transactions 15-11
16 Prediction
16.1 Teller Service Counters Prediction 16-1
17 Cache
17.1 Clear Cache 17-1
18 Customer Service
18.1 Cheque Status Inquiry 18-2
18.2 Stop Cheque Request 18-3
18.3 Cheque Book Request 18-4
18.4 Passbook Issue 18-6
18.5 Passbook Update 18-8
18.6 Passbook Status Change 18-10
18.7 Passbook Reprint 18-11
18.8 Account Balance Inquiry 18-13
18.9 Account Statement Request 18-16
18.10 Customer Address Update 18-18
18.11 Account Address Update 18-19
18.12 Customer Contact Update 18-21
18.13 Cheque Book Status Change 18-22
19 Branch Dashboard
20 Branch Maintenance
20.1 Common Actions for Branch Maintenance 20-3
20.2 Maintain Teller Branch Parameters 20-3
20.3 Maintain Branch Role Limits 20-5
20.4 Maintain Branch User Preferences 20-7
20.5 Maintain Denominations 20-9
ix
20.6 Maintain Function Code Definitions 20-11
20.7 Maintain Function Code Preferences 20-15
20.8 Maintain Default Authorizer 20-21
20.9 Maintain Accounting and Settlements 20-22
20.10 Maintain Instrument Numbers 20-25
20.11 Maintain Inter Branch Transit Account 20-26
20.12 Maintain External System 20-28
20.13 Maintain Channel Limits 20-30
20.14 Maintain Account Group 20-32
20.15 Maintain Branch Group 20-33
20.16 Maintain Customer Group 20-34
20.17 Maintain Charge Definitions 20-36
20.18 Create Charge Pricing Maintenance 20-38
20.19 View Charge Pricing Maintenance 20-40
20.20 Maintain Charge Condition Group 20-41
20.20.1 Additional Information on Parameters 20-42
20.21 Maintain Charge Decisions 20-43
20.22 Charge Decision Enquiry 20-45
20.23 Maintain Reject Codes 20-47
20.24 Maintain Clearing Network Codes 20-48
20.25 Maintain Denomination Variations 20-50
20.26 Maintain External Bank Codes 20-51
20.27 Maintain Issuer Codes 20-52
20.28 Maintain Utility Providers 20-53
20.29 Maintain Account Entitlement Restriction 20-55
C Advices
x
Index
xi
Audience
Preface
This guide helps you to familiarize yourself with the Oracle Banking Branch
application. It gives an overview of the module and explains all the maintenances
required for its smooth functioning. It also takes you through the different types of
transactions that can be handled through this module.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Audience
• Related Resources
• Conventions
• Symbols, Definitions, and Shortcut Keys
• List of Topics
• Screenshot Disclaimer
Audience
This guide is intended for the Branch Tellers, Vault Operators, and Branch Supervisors
to provide quick and efficient service to customers and prospects of your bank.
Related Resources
The related documents are as follows:
• Getting Started User Guide
• Current Account and Savings Account User Guide
• Servicing Configurations User Guide
Conventions
The following text conventions are used in this document:
Convention Meaning
boldface Boldface type indicates graphical user interface elements associated
with an action, or terms defined in text or the glossary.
italic Italic type indicates book titles, emphasis, or placeholder variables for
which you supply particular values.
monospace Monospace type indicates commands within a paragraph, URLs, code
in examples, text that appears on the screen, or text that you enter.
12
Symbols, Definitions, and Shortcut Keys
Table Symbols
Symbol Function
Add icon
Add a row
Edit icon
Delete icon
Calendar icon
Close icon
Delete a row
Grid view
Increase/Decrease value
List view
Maximize
Minimize
Open a list
Perform search
Refresh
Most of the screens contain icons to perform all or a few of the basic actions. The actions
which are called here are generic, and it varies based on the usage and the applicability. The
table below gives a snapshot of them:
13
Symbols, Definitions, and Shortcut Keys
Icon Description
Submit Click Submit to complete the transaction after you specify all the
input parameters for a particular transaction.
Cancel Click Cancel to cancel the transaction input midway without
saving any data.
Clear Click Clear to clear the transaction input data. The system
displays a pop-up screen with confirmation to clear data. You can
The following shortcut keys can be used only for the screens which have the icons
specified in the Function column:
Note:
The last field of the last accordion
will shift focus to Submit/Cancel
button.
Acronym/ Description
Abbreviation
ARC Account, Rate, and Charge
BC Bankers Cheque
14
List of Topics
Acronym/ Description
Abbreviation
CASA Current Account and Saving Account
CCY Currency
CIF Customer Information File
DD Demand Draft
EJ Electronic Journal
FCY Foreign Currency
FX Foreign Exchange
GL General Ledger
HO Head Office
LCY Local Currency
LOV List of Values
MIS Management Information System
ML Machine Learning
RD Recurring Deposit
SD Safe Deposits
System Unless specified, it shall always refer to Oracle Banking
Branch.
TC Travellers Cheque
TD Term Deposit
UDF User Defined Fields
VAT Value Added Tax
List of Topics
This guide is organized into the following topics:
Topic Description
Overview of Oracle This topic provides a snapshot of the features of the application.
Banking Branch
Branch Operations This topic describes the internal activities done at the branch where the
Customer is not involved.
Till-Vault Operations This topic describes the various screens used to perform the Till Vault
operations.
Customer Transactions This topic describes the various screens used to perform financial
transactions for Customer accounts.
Miscellaneous This topic describes the various screens used to perform General
Transactions Ledger (GL) transactions.
15
Screenshot Disclaimer
Topic Description
Transfers This topic describes the various screens used to perform inter-bank
transfer, intra-bank transfer, and cross-border transactions.
Clearing Transactions This topic describes the various screens used to capture the Inward
Clearing Data Entry, Outward Clearing Data Entry, Cheque Return, and
Cheque Deposit transactions.
Remittances This topic describes the various screens used to perform various types
of remittances.
Term Deposit Transactions This topic describes the various screens used to open, redeem, and
top-up a term deposit.
Credit Card Transactions This topic describes the various screens used to perform credit card
advance and payment transactions.
Loan Transactions This topic describes the various screens used to perform loan
disbursement and loan repayment transactions.
Islamic Transactions This topic describes the various screens used to perform various
Islamic transactions.
Bill Payments This topic describes the various screens used to perform various bill
payment transactions.
Session Teller This topic describes the various screens used to perform financial
Transactions transactions for Customer accounts in the Teller Session.
Journal Log This topic describes the various screens used to view the status of
transactions performed, resubmit or reject an incomplete transaction,
and reverse a completed transaction.
Prediction This topic describes the screen that is used to predict the number of
service counters required for a specific period.
Cache This topic describes the Clear Cache screen, which is used to get the
maintenance reflected while performing the transactions.
Customer Service This topic describes the various screens used to maintain customer
accounts and ancillary services and to enquire about customer account
balance.
Branch Dashboard This topic describes the dashboard used to view the cash position,
transaction status, alerts, to access the frequently used transaction
screens, and to view the alerts and notifications.
Branch Maintenance This topic describes the various screens used to perform branch
maintenance.
Screenshot Disclaimer
Personal information used in the interface or documents are dummy and does not
exist in the real world. It is only for reference purposes.
16
1
Overview of Oracle Banking Branch
Oracle Banking Branch is a retail banking application that gives a 360-degree view of the
customer and financial transactions to the Teller of the bank.
Oracle Banking Branch you as the Teller, to provide better customer-focused services as well
as cross-sell and up-sell the other products and services of the bank. A typical transaction
under a branch is classified into the following stages:
Stage Description
Teller Request In this stage, the Teller captures the transaction request and
transaction enrichment.
Authorization In this stage, the Supervisor authorizes the request.
Teller Resubmission The Resubmission stage is applicable only for certain transactions.
1-1
Chapter 1
Prerequisites
1.1 Prerequisites
Before you begin performing transactions, you need to log in to the Oracle Banking
Branch Homepage.
For information on how to log in, refer to the Getting Started User Guide. You can also
launch the Oracle Banking Branch application through the FLEXCUBE Universal
Banking.
To launch Oracle Banking Branch through FLEXCUBE Universal Banking:
1. Log in to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking Homepage. For information on how to
log in, refer to the Procedures User Guide in the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking
Documentation Library.
The FLEXCUBE Universal Banking Homepage is displayed.
2. Specify CSDNGUIM in the top right corner text box, and click Next.
The Next Gen UI Products Maintenance screen is displayed.
Note:
Make sure that the user has roles for the screen.
3. On the Next Gen UI Products Maintenance screen, update the Next Generation
UI Product URL.
Note:
For example, NEW TELLER can be used as the Function id, with the
description as Teller Next Generation Product. It is released as
Static Data and ensures the user roles are maintained for the same in
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking.
1-2
Chapter 1
Prerequisites
4. Once the roles are maintained in FLEXCUBE Universal Banking, click Next Generation
UI on the toolbar.
The Next Gen UI Dashboard is displayed with the list of products.
Note:
Make sure that the same user id is maintained in FLEXCUBE Universal
Banking. In addition, make sure that the Next Generation UI is maintained and
has the necessary roles. For example, if the user ID is Jones, the same needs
to be present in the SMS systems of FLEXCUBE Universal Banking and Next
Generation UI.
Configuration Value
INTEGRATION_ENABLED {id} true
INTEGRATION_CALLBACK_URL https://10.00.00.00:1010/FCJNeoWeb/
{id} ValidationService/FCNonceValidation/
validate
Note:
The IP and port number of the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking server must be
updated.
1-3
Chapter 1
About Main Menu
1-4
Chapter 1
About Main Menu
Menu Description
Branch Operations Branch Manager, Vault Teller, or Teller can use Branch Operations to
cover the internal activities done at the branch where the Customer is
not involved. This facilitates branch, vault, Till opening, or closing for
the day and monitoring the transactions done during the day, and Cash
Balancing.
Till-Vault Operations Vault Teller or Teller can use Till-Vault Operations to monitor the cash
and currency boxes for the day and to perform cash transfers from or to
the Vault or Till as and when required.
Customer Transactions Teller can use Customer Transactions to perform financial
transactions for Customer accounts, which includes, Cash Deposits,
Cash Withdrawals, Cheque Withdrawals, Forex Transactions, and
Account Closure.
Miscellaneous Teller can use Miscellaneous Transactions to perform General
Transactions Ledger transactions such as miscellaneous debit and credit
transactions against a Customer’s CASA account and GL account.
Transfers Teller can use Transfers to perform inter-bank transfers, intra-bank
transfers, and cross-border transactions.
Clearing Teller can use Clearing to capture the Inward Clearing Data Entry,
Outward Clearing Data Entry, Cheque Return, and Cheque Deposit
transactions.
Remittances Teller can use Remittances to issue remittances such as demand
drafts and banker's cheques, perform payment or cancellation of the
issued remittances, and perform further operations on the issued
remittances.
Term Deposits Teller can use Term Deposits to initiate Term Deposit account opening
and perform a redemption, top-up on the existing term deposit
accounts.
Credit Card Transactions Tellers can use Credit Card Transactions to perform credit card
advance and payment transactions.
Loan Transactions Teller can use Loan Transactions to perform loan disbursement and
loan repayment transactions.
Islamic Transactions Teller can use to Islamic Transactions perform various Islamic
transactions.
Bill Payments Teller can use Bill Payments to perform various bill payment
transactions.
Session Teller Teller can use Session Teller Transactions to perform financial
Transactions transactions for Customer accounts in the Teller Session.
Journal Log Teller or Supervisor can use Journal Log to view the status of
transactions performed by them. Also, it allows to resubmit or reject an
incomplete transaction, or to reverse a completed transaction.
Prediction The Supervisor can use Prediction to predict the number of service
counters required for a specific period.
Cache The Clear Cache screen is used to get the maintenance reflected
while performing the transactions.
Customer Service Teller or Operations Executive can use Customer Service to maintain
customer accounts and ancillary services and to enquire about
customer account balance.
1-5
Chapter 1
Application Layout
Menu Description
Branch Dashboard Teller can use the Branch Dashboard to view the cash position,
transaction status, alerts, to access the frequently used transaction
screens, and to view the alerts and notifications.
Branch Maintenance Branch Maintenance covers a set of definitions maintained to perform
the branch-based operations, transactions, and services.
Customer/Account Search Used to query for a specific Customer ID or Customer Account
Number.
the icon.
1-6
Chapter 1
Application Layout
2. On the Customer Search screen, query the details. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Field Description
Customer ID Specify the customer ID which the details need to be queried.
Customer Name Specify the name of the customer for which the details need to be
queried.
Account Number Specify the account number for which the details need to be
queried.
Search Click Search to get the results for the specified Customer ID,
Customer Name, or Account Number.
Reset Click Reset to clear the search results.
Customer Results Displays the customer search results.
Customer ID Displays the customer ID.
Customer Name Displays the customer's name.
Account Details Displays the account search results.
Account Number Display the account number.
Account Name Display the description of the account.
Account Currency Display the currency of the account.
1-7
Chapter 1
Application Layout
Transaction Header
The transaction header is specific to each transaction screen. The following details are
provided in the transaction header:
Item Description
Transaction Screen Name Displays the name of the selected transaction screen.
Customer Search For information on the Customer Search, refer to
Customer Search.
Branch Date Displays the current branch date.
Transaction Panel
The transaction panel consists of the data segments with the necessary input fields
and action buttons. Users need to specify the details in the fields to perform the
transactions.
Customer Information
The Customer Information widget provides the details about the customer that are
validated during transaction submission. For information on the amount-based
signature verification, refer to About Amount-Based Signature Verification.
Field Description
Display Option The Customer Information widget is displayed only if this option
is selected.
Customer's Image Displays the image of the customer.
Customer's Name Displays the name of the customer.
KYC Status Displays the KYC status of the customer's details.
1-8
Chapter 1
Salient Features
Field Description
Signature Displays the signature of the customer.
Account Details Displays the details of the customer account.
Address Details Displays the address details of the customer.
Contact Details Displays the contact details of the customer.
Additional Widgets
The additional widgets are located at the right side of the transaction area in the Teller
Transaction screens. The additional widgets include the following:
Widget Description
Current Till Position Displays the cash position in the branch currency for the logged-in
Teller Id.
Memo Alerts Displays the instructions maintained in FLEXCUBE Universal Banking
for the specified account number.
Note:
To enable memo alerts, in transaction
schema the memo_enabled flag should
be set to ‘Y’ in
SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS and UBS
Entries should be maintained.
Note:
The system displays an error message
stating that the User does not have rights
to access this screen if the user is trying
to access the restricted screen in the
widget.
1-9
Chapter 1
Salient Features
Feature Description
Generation of Teller The system generates a unique Teller Sequence Number and
Sequence Number displays an information message Teller Sequence
Number nnn indicating the generated number after submission
of each teller transaction. The generated sequence number is
also displayed at the following levels:
• Completion
• Authorization Submission
• Re-submission
• Reversal
• Rejection
Advice Generation for The system generates the transaction advice if it is enabled in the
Teller Transactions definition of function code. The advice includes the currency and
amount values involved in the transaction.
Transaction Approval When you perform a transaction for an amount greater than the
allowed limit, it needs approval from the Supervisor. Based on the
Assignment Mode in Function Code Preferences screen, the
following conditions apply:
• Manual – The system will show a list of approval if the
request status is Approval.
• Auto – The transaction is automatically assigned to the
default authorizer if the request status is Approval.
The transaction approval flow consists of the following steps:
• Initiation
• Pending Approval
• Pending
• Completed
For more information on transaction approval flow, refer to
Table 1-9.
Transaction Reversal A transaction can be reversed with auto-approval or approval from
with Approval the Supervisor. Based on the Assignment Mode in Function
Code Preferences screen, the following conditions apply:
• Manual – The system will show a list of approval if the
request status is Approval.
• Auto – The transaction is automatically assigned to the
default authorizer if the request status is Approval.
The transaction approval flow consists of the following steps:
• Completed
• Pending Approval
• Pending
• Reversed
For more information on transaction flow for reversal with
approval, refer to Table 1-10.
1-10
Chapter 1
Salient Features
Feature Description
Transaction Reversal A transaction can be manually reversed only when it is authorized
and completed from the Journal Log.
When you reverse a transaction, the data remains in the system
with the status Reversed and the accounting entries are reversed
(negative amounts are posted into the accounts). Also, this will
update the Till Balance for the currencies (for cash transactions),
wherever applicable.
You can select the transaction to be reversed from the transaction
screen. If the reversal is applicable for the function code, the
Reversal icon will be enabled. When you click this icon, the
reversal request will be initiated.
If cash transactions are reversed, the system validates the
following:
• the Till used for the reversal is the same as that used in the
original transaction
• the denominations are input (If the transaction is reversed the
same day of its input, the denominations of the transaction
are altered.)
• a batch is open
Transaction Rejection You can manually reject the authorized customer transactions
from the Teller Journal Log.
Note:
When you reject a transaction, the
data remains in the system with the
contract status Discarded and no
further action is allowed on the
transaction.
UDF and MIS UDF and MIS are supported during accounting via common core
Additional Fields. MIS Codes can be sent from the Oracle
Banking Branch, which will be validated and processed as part of
accounting.
1-11
Chapter 1
Salient Features
Feature Description
External API External APIs will be processed only if called by an external
system, which is maintained in Oracle Banking Branch. The
external system can be maintained using the External System
Maintenance screen. For more information on the External
System Maintenance screen, refer to External System
Maintenance. External APIs are supported for the following
transactions:
• Cash Deposit
• Cash Withdrawal
• Account Balance Inquiry
• Account Transfer
Note:
These transactions will work only if
OAuth is enabled.
Stage Description
Initiation to Pending If the transaction amount exceeds the limit defined in Branch User
Approval Limits and on click of Submit, the system shows a popup
message Amount exceeds limit for this
transaction, and request status is shown as Approval.
If assignment mode is manual and on click of Confirm, the
system shows a list of approval based on branch code,
transaction amount, currency, and function code. The user can
give a narrative and click Submit for Approval button.
Pending Approval to The Approver/Supervisor needs to log in and fetch the transaction
Pending from Journal Log with transaction status as Pending Approval.
The Supervisor can approve the pending transaction by clicking
Approve/Reject with the supervisor comment.
Pending to Completed The user needs to fetch the transaction from Journal Log with
transaction status as Sent Back and click Submit.
1-12
Chapter 1
Salient Features
Stage Description
Override Flow (Initiation Based on the branch maintenance setup at certain levels like
to Completed) Function Code, Function Code Preferences, Branch User Limits,
and Branch role limits, if the transaction is validated with any
warning override, the system shows a popup message with
request status as Warning. Once the user confirms, the
transaction status will be shown as Completed.
Stage Description
Completed to Pending The completed transaction can be selected from the Electronic
Approval Journal screen. Once you click Reverse, the system shows a popup
message Amount required for Reversal and requests
changes to Approval.
If assignment mode is manual and on click of Confirm, the system
shows a list of approval based on branch code, transaction amount,
currency, and function code. The user can give a narrative and click
Submit for Approval button.
Pending Approval to The Approver/Supervisor needs to log in and fetch the transaction from
Pending Journal Log with transaction status as Pending Approval. The
Supervisor can approve the pending transaction by clicking Approve/
Reject with the supervisor comment.
Pending to Reversed The user needs to fetch the transaction from Journal Log with
transaction status as Sent Back and click Submit.
Override Flow (Completed The user needs to select the completed transaction in the Electronic
to Approval) Journal screen and click Reverse. If the Reversal Requires
Authorization is enabled in the Function Code Definition screen, the
system displays an information message to select the Approver based
on Manual or Auto assignment mode. After selecting the approver
internally, reversal override will be called and request status will be
updated as Approval.
1-13
Chapter 1
Salient Features
The following conditions apply to the machine learning use case for cheque book
requests:
• If sufficient details are provided in the email request, the transaction will be
processed until completion.
• If details are insufficient in the email request to process a transaction, it will be
assigned in the Servicing Journal for user correction. After the assigned user
does the correction, the transaction will be processed.
1-14
Chapter 1
Salient Features
View Request
In the Electronic Journal, you can view the details of the Cheque Book Request initiated
through the email request. The View Request button will be enabled for the transactions that
are submitted or completed. You can view the details of the email request by clicking the
View Request.
1-15
Chapter 1
Salient Features
If sufficient details are provided in the email request for card block, the transaction will
be processed until completion.
Note:
Teller needs to type/say
the specific account
number while giving the
input text/voice.
1-16
Chapter 1
Salient Features
1-17
Chapter 1
Salient Features
Validations
If Virtual Identifier is enabled, the validation is performed as follows:
• After you specify the account number, and on tab out, the system will validate the
specified account number.
• If the account number is invalid, the system prompts an information message to
input the currency and amount.
• Once the currency and amount are entered, the virtual identifier service will be
invoked to validate if it is a valid virtual account or not.
1-18
Chapter 1
Salient Features
1-19
Chapter 1
Salient Features
1-20
Chapter 1
Salient Features
1-21
Chapter 1
Keyboard Navigation for Transaction Screens
Select from Drop-down To select a value from the drop-down list, perform the following
Lists steps:
1. Press Tab/Shift + Tab keys to navigate to the desired drop-
down list.
2. Use Arrow keys to navigate to the desired value.
3. Press Enter key to select the value.
Select from List of To select a value from the list of values, perform the following
Values steps:
1. Press Tab/Shift + Tab keys to navigate to the desired list of
values.
2. Press Enter key or Spacebar to enter into the list of values.
3. If the exact value is known, specify the value in the search
field, and press the Tab key to navigate to the Fetch button.
Press Enter key to select the Fetch button.
The results will be fetched based on the input value.
4. Press the Tab key to navigate to the results.
5. Use Arrow keys to navigate to the desired value.
6. Press Spacebar to select the value.
1-22
Chapter 1
About Business Process Codes
Select Option Buttons/ To select option buttons, perform the following steps:
Icons
1. Press Tab/Shift + Tab keys to navigate to the desired option
button.
2. Press Enter key or Spacebar to select the desired option
button.
Note:
For more information on the business process, refer to the Servicing Configurations
User Guide.
1-23
2
Branch Operations
The Branch Manager, Vault Teller, or Teller can use branch operations to perform the internal
activities done at the branch where the customer is not involved.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• TC Denomination Enquiry
The TC Denomination Enquiry screen is used to enquire the currency-wise details of
the TCs in the branch vault.
• Open Branch Batch
The Open Branch Batch screen is used to initiate the branch operations for the posting
date. The Supervisor or Branch Manager with necessary access can open this screen.
• Open Vault Batch
The Vault Teller can use Open Vault Batch screen to open a vault batch on a specified
date.
• Open Teller Batch
The Open Teller Batch screen is used to open a teller batch on a specified date.
• Current Open Tills
The Current Open Tills screen is used to view the open tills or vault for the branch
during the day or before performing the end-of-day activity.
• Branch Breach Limits
The Branch Breach Limits screen helps to view the details of Till or Vault, which is
breaching the currency limits along with the current balance position.
• Till Vault Position
The Till Vault Position screen is used to view the cash position of all the currencies at
any time for the Teller ID or Vault ID, which is logged in for the current posting date. It
also shows the denomination details.
• Branch Total Position
The supervisor can use this screen to view the currency-wise cash position of all the
Tellers and Vault Teller on the posting date for the logged-in branch.
• Close Teller Batch
The Close Teller Batch screen is used to close the teller batch for the given posting
date.
• Close Vault Batch
The Close Vault Batch screen is used to close the vault batch for a specific date.
• Close Branch Batch
The Close Branch Batch screen is used to close the branch batch after confirming that
all the branch transactions have been accounted for in the account books.
• Book Shortage
The Teller or Vault Teller can use the Book Shortage screen to book the shortage if the
actual or physical cash present is less than the system cash.
2-1
Chapter 2
TC Denomination Enquiry
• Book Overage
The Teller or Vault Teller can use this screen to book the physical cash held in a
particular currency, which exceeds the cash in that currency shown in the system.
• Teller Session
The teller can perform several transactions for a customer in a single session. All
the transactions done by the customer are grouped under a single session. At the
end of the session, the teller accepts the cumulative amount (of all the
transactions done in the session) from the customer.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
2-2
Chapter 2
Open Branch Batch
Field Description
Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
Posting Date Displays the current posting date of the branch.
Till Vault Indicator Select the Till Vault Indicator from the drop-down values (Till or
Vault).
Till ID Displays the Till ID.
TC Currency Click the search icon, and select the TC currency from the list of
values.
Issuer Code Click the search icon, and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Refresh After you specify the TC Currency and Issuer Code fields, click
Refresh to fetch and display the details of the TC.
Denomination Code Displays the denomination code of the TC.
Description Displays the description of the denomination code.
System Count Displays the system count.
Series Displays the series.
Start Number Displays the start number.
End Number Displays the end number.
Amount Displays the amount.
2-3
Chapter 2
Open Vault Batch
2. On the Open Branch Batch screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the branch batch needs to be
opened.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
3. Click Submit.
The branch batch is opened for the specified posting date.
Note:
Opening branch batch indicates to the head office that the branch is
open for business operations on the specified posting date. You can
open a Teller batch for the posting date only after the branch batch is
opened.
2-4
Chapter 2
Open Vault Batch
2. On the Open Vault Batch screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Field Description
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the vault batch needs to be opened.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
Note:
The amount shown in this column depends on the cash
transactions that were carried out by the vault until the
last posting date.
2-5
Chapter 2
Open Teller Batch
Field Description
Shortage/Overage Displays the difference between the total cash and the cash
Amount available in the Vault, at the end of the current posting date.
Currency Displays the currency code.
Denomination Displays the denomination code.
Total Units Specify the total units available while closing the batch.
Total Value Displays the total value based on the total units.
System Units Displays the units available in the system.
System Total Displays the total value available in the system.
Shortage/Overage Units Displays the shortage/overage units.
Shortage/Overage Displays the shortage/overage amount.
Amount
Total Cash Amount Displays the total cash amount.
Denomination Total Displays the total denomination value with the currency.
Validate Denominations Click this button to calculate and display the Total Cash and
Shortage/Overage Amount fields based on the currency selected.
3. Click Submit.
The vault batch is opened for the specified posting date.
Note:
During the vault batch opening, the system will internally transfer the
available balance from the Primary vault of the branch to the current
open Vault ID. The Vault Teller can perform the relevant vault operations
for the posting date. The system does not allow to open the vault batch if
the physical cash entered is not the same as the system cash.
2-6
Chapter 2
Open Teller Batch
2. On the Open Teller Batch screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Field Description
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the vault batch needs to be opened.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
Note:
The amount shown in this column depends on the cash
transactions that were carried out by the vault until the
last posting date.
2-7
Chapter 2
Current Open Tills
Field Description
Shortage/ Overage Displays the difference between the total cash and the cash
Amount available with the Teller, at the end of the current posting date.
Based on this difference, the overage or the shortage amount is
displayed.
Note:
An overage indicates that the physical cash with the
Teller is more than the available cash as calculated by
the system. A shortage indicates that the available cash
calculated by the system is more than the physical cash
present with the Teller.
3. Click Submit.
The teller batch is opened for the specified posting date.
Note:
The Teller can perform the relevant teller operations for the posting date.
The system does not allow to open the vault batch if the physical cash
entered is not the same as the system cash. The system also allows to
re-open the Teller batch for the current system date.
2-8
Chapter 2
Current Open Tills
• Pending
• User Working
• Assigned
To view the open tills or vault:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Branch Operations, click Current
Open Tills or specify Current Open Tills in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The Current Open Tills screen is displayed.
2. On the Current Open Tills screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch.
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the current open tills need to be
enquired.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
2-9
Chapter 2
Branch Breach Limits
2. On the Branch Breach Limits screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch.
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the branch breaching limits needs
to be enquired.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
2-10
Chapter 2
Till Vault Position
Field Description
Vault User Displays the checkbox if the User ID is a Vault Teller.
Currency Displays the list of currencies in which the User ID has
performed the transactions.
Minimum Limit Displays the minimum till balance that needs to be maintained
for the User ID and currency combination.
Maximum Limit Displays the maximum till balance that needs to be maintained
for the User ID and currency combination.
Current Till Balance Displays the current till balance based on the till cash position
for the specified currency.
Branch Breaching Limit Displays the values under this section.
Branch Code Displays the code of the logged-in branch.
Currency Displays the currency code.
Minimum Limit Displays the minimum limit that needs to be maintained for the
branch.
Maximum Limit Displays the maximum limit that needs to be maintained for the
branch.
Current Total Balance Displays the branch total cash position, currency-wise.
2-11
Chapter 2
Branch Total Position
2. On the Till Vault Position screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch.
Branch Posting Date Displays the date on which the Till/Vault batch is opened.
Teller/Vault ID Displays the logged-in Teller ID or Vault Teller ID.
Currency Details Specify the fields under this section.
Currency Displays the currency code.
Opening Balance Displays the opening balance of the till or vault.
Incoming Cash Amount Displays the incoming cash in the till or vault for the current
posting date.
Outgoing Cash Amount Displays the outgoing cash in the till or vault for the current
posting date.
Total Cash Displays the total cash available in the till or vault.
Till Vault Indicator Displays whether the currency details apply to Till or Vault. (T
or V)
Denomination Details Displays the denomination details under this section.
Denomination Code Displays the denomination code maintained for the currency.
Denomination Value Displays the denominations maintained for the currency.
Opening Balance Displays the opening balance in the Till or vault in terms of
denominations.
Incoming Cash Amount Displays the incoming cash in the Till or vault in terms of
denominations.
Outgoing Cash Amount Displays the outgoing cash in the Till or vault in terms of
denominations.
Total Cash Displays the total cash currently available in the Till or vault for
the day in terms of denominations.
Units Displays the total units available for the specific denomination
code.
2-12
Chapter 2
Branch Total Position
2. On the Branch Total Position screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch.
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the teller totals position need to be
enquired.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
Currency Displays the currency code for which the teller totals details needs
to be displayed.
Teller ID Displays the logged-in teller ID from the LOV.
All Till Select this radio button to display all the open Teller Till details of
the day.
All Vault Select this radio button to display all the open Vault details of the
day.
All Till and Vault Select this radio button to display all the open Till and open Vault
details of the day.
Query Displays the details if you click this icon.
Currency Displays the currency code for which the cash position is shown.
Teller ID Displays the Teller ID for which the cash position is shown.
Opening Balance Displays the opening balance of the Teller ID for the specific
currency.
Incoming Cash Displays the total incoming cash received in the Till.
Outgoing Cash Displays the outgoing cash moved out of the Till.
Closing Balance Displays the total amount pending in the Till.
2-13
Chapter 2
Close Teller Batch
Note:
The teller batch can be opened and closed only once for the posting date.
2. On the Close Teller Batch screen, specify the details. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
2-14
Chapter 2
Close Teller Batch
Field Description
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the teller batch needs to be closed.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
Note:
The amount displayed in this column depends on the
cash transactions that were carried out by the Teller until
the last posting date.
Shortage/ Overage Displays the difference between the Total Cash and the Cash
Amount Available. Based on this difference, the overage or the shortage
amount is displayed.
Note:
An overage indicates that the physical cash with the
Teller is more than the available cash as calculated by
the system. A shortage indicates that the available cash
calculated by the system is more than the physical cash
present with the Teller.
2-15
Chapter 2
Close Teller Batch
Note:
If there is any overage or shortage, the system displays an error
message stating that the cash/TC is not balanced for the Teller ID. Also,
if any of the conditions mentioned above fail, the system displays an
appropriate error message on submit.
Validate the TC denomination details. For more information on fields, refer to the field
description table.
Field Description
TC Currency Displays the TC currency code in which the Teller deals.
Total TC Amount Displays the total TC amount for a particular currency, physically
present in the bank Teller, at the end of the current posting date.
2-16
Chapter 2
Close Teller Batch
Field Description
TC Available Displays the TC for a particular currency, which is available in the
teller at the end of the current posting date.
Note:
The amount displayed in this
column depends on the cash
transactions that were carried out by
the Teller until the last posting date.
Shortage/ Overage Displays the difference between the total cash and the cash
Amount available with the Teller, at the end of the current posting date.
Based on this difference, the overage or the shortage amount is
displayed.
Note:
An overage indicates that the
physical cash with the Teller is more
than the available cash as
calculated by the system. A
shortage indicates that the available
cash calculated by the system is
more than the physical cash present
with the Teller.
2-17
Chapter 2
Close Vault Batch
Field Description
Validate TC Click this button to calculate and display the Total Cash and
Denominations Shortage/Overage Amount fields based on the currency
selected.
Note:
The Vault Teller can close the vault batch even if the Tills are open. When the
Vault Batch is closed, the user will not be able to post transactions like Buy
Cash from Vault that involve Vault.
2-18
Chapter 2
Close Vault Batch
2. On the Close Vault Batch screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Field Description
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the vault batch needs to be closed.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
Currency Displays the currency code in which the Vault Teller deals.
Total Cash Specify the total cash for a particular currency, physically present in
the bank Vault Teller, at the end of the current posting date.
Cash Available Displays the system calculated cash for a particular currency, which
is available in the Vault Teller at the end of the current posting date.
Note:
The amount displayed in this column depends on the
cash transactions that were carried out by the Teller until
the last posting date.
Shortage/Overage Displays the difference between the total cash and the cash
Amount available in the Vault, at the end of the current posting date.
Currency Displays the currency code.
Denomination Displays the denomination code.
2-19
Chapter 2
Close Branch Batch
Field Description
Total Units Specify the total units available while closing the batch.
Total Value Displays the total value based on the total units.
System Units Displays the units available in the system.
System Total Displays the total value available in the system.
Shortage/Overage Units Displays the shortage/overage units.
Shortage/Overage Displays the shortage/overage amount.
Amount
Total Cash Amount Displays the total cash amount.
Denomination Total Displays the total denomination value with the currency.
3. Specify the denomination details for the Traveller’s Cheque. For information on the
fields in the TC Denomination Details segment, refer to Add TC Denomination
Details.
4. Click Submit.
The cash balance is updated and the vault batch is closed for the posting date.
Note:
During vault batch closure, the system will internally transfer the closing
balance from the current open Vault ID to the Primary vault of the
branch. If there is any overage or shortage, the system displays an error
message stating that the cash is not balanced for the Teller ID. Also, if
any of the conditions mentioned above fail, the system displays an
appropriate error on submit.
2-20
Chapter 2
Book Shortage
2. On the Close Branch Batch screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Posting Date Indicates the date on which the branch batch needs to be closed.
Note:
By default, the system displays the current date.
3. Click Submit.
The branch batch is closed for the specified posting date.
2-21
Chapter 2
Book Shortage
2. On the Book Shortage screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Displays the local currency of the branch.
Specify the amount that needs to be booked for the shortage.
Note:
The user can select another currency from the drop-
down values in which the shortage amount is to be
booked.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the system
reduces the cash balance by this transaction amount to synchronize with
physical cash held with Teller.
2-22
Chapter 2
Book Shortage
Validate the denomination details. For more information on fields, refer to the field description
table.
Field Description
Denom Code Displays the unique denomination codes for each currency.
Units Indicates the number of units for the specified denomination.
Note:
By default, the till contents are
incremented for inflow transactions such
as cash deposits and decremented for
outflow transactions such as cash
withdrawal. To reverse the transaction,
you can specify units in negative.
2-23
Chapter 2
Book Overage
Field Description
Value Displays the system-computed face value of the denomination based
on the number of units.
Note:
For example, if the denomination code
represents USD 100 and the unit is
specified as 3, the value will be displayed
as 300.
Note:
For example, if the denomination code
represents USD 100 and the number of
units is 10, the denomination amount will
be 1000.
Note:
The system computes the Denomination
Amount and validates the amount if it is
equal to the Total Cash Amount. It also
prompts an error during saving if there is
any difference.
2-24
Chapter 2
Book Overage
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Till-Vault Operations, click Book
Overage or specify Book Overage in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The Book Overage screen is displayed.
2. On the Book Overage screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Displays the local currency of the branch.
Specify the amount that needs to be booked for the overage.
Note:
The user can select another currency from the drop-
down values in which the shortage amount is to be
booked.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
2-25
Chapter 2
Teller Session
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the system
increases the cash balance by this transaction amount to synchronize
with physical cash held with Teller.
2-26
Chapter 2
Teller Session
2. On the Start Teller Session screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Number Specify the customer number.
Note:
You can also select from the list of values, which displays
all the open and authorized CIF IDs maintained in the
system.
Operation Type Select the operation types of the customer from the drop-down list.
The drop-down list shows the following values:
• Transaction
• Account/Contract
• Both
Note:
By default, the Transaction value is selected.
Incoming Cash Amount Specify the cash amount at the start of the teller session.
Remarks Enter remarks for the transaction.
3. On the Start Teller Session screen, click on the CIF Details data segment.
The CIF Details data segment is displayed with the fields.
2-27
Chapter 2
Teller Session
4. Specify the CIF details. For more information on fields, refer to the field description
table.
Field Description
Executor CIF Number When you press the Tab key, the system defaults the value
which can be modified.
Executor CIF Name Displays the executor CIF.
Beneficial Owner CIF Select the desired value from the option list, which displays all
Number the open and authorized CIF IDs maintained in the system.
Beneficial Owner CIF Displays the beneficial owner's CIF number.
Number
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
2-28
Chapter 2
Teller Session
2. On the Stop Teller Session screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Number Displays the customer number associated with the selected session
ID.
Note:
When you launch the Stop Teller Session, its
corresponding customer number will be populated in this
field.
2-29
Chapter 2
Teller Session
3. On the Stop Teller Session screen, click on the Teller Transaction Details data
segment.
The Teller Transaction Details data segment is displayed.
4. On the Teller Transaction Details segment, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Transaction Reference Displays the reference number of the transactions completed
No within the teller session.
Function Id Displays the Function ID of the transactions that occurred
within the teller session.
Teller Sequence Displays the unique sequence number generated for the teller
Number to check the transaction in EJ Log.
Transaction Amount Displays the Total Transaction Amount for the particular
Transaction Reference No.
Total Charge Amount Displays the Total Charge Amount for the specified
Transaction Reference No. Click on the eye button to view
the individual charges maintained for the transaction.
5. On the Stop Teller Session screen, click on the Teller Session Denomination
Details data segment.
The Teller Session Denomination Details data segment is displayed.
6. On the Teller Session Denomination Details segment, specify the fields. For
more information on fields, refer to the field description table.
2-30
Chapter 2
Teller Session
Field Description
Transaction Currency Displays the currency for the Total Transaction Amount.
Total Transaction Amount Displays the total transaction amount for a particular currency within
the teller session.
Cash In/Out Displays the cash in/out value for the Total Transaction Amount.
Add Denomination Click Add to view the denominations maintained for the transaction
currency and to enter the denomination units. For more information
on this segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
7. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
2-31
3
Till-Vault Operations
The Vault Teller or Teller can use Till-Vault operations to monitor the cash and currency boxes
for the day. It is also used to perform cash transfers from or to the Vault/Till.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Buy TC from Agent
The Buy TC from Agent screen is used to buy TC from agents into the branch’s vault.
Only a Vault user can access this screen.
• Buy TC from Head Office
The Buy TC from HO screen is used to buy TC from head office into branch’s vault. Only
a Vault user can access this screen.
• Buy TC from Vault
The Buy TC from Vault screen is used to buy TC from the vault to transfer TCs into
logged-in Teller’s Till. Only a Teller can access this screen.
• Return TC to Vault
The Teller can use the Return TC to Vault screen to return TC to the branch’s vault.
• Return TC to HO
The Return TC to HO screen is used to sell TC to the HO, and only a Vault Teller can
access this screen.
• Buy Cash from Currency Chest
The Vault Teller can use this screen to get cash from the currency chest after opening the
vault batch and deposit it into the vault. Once the cash is transferred from the currency
chest, the system updates the cash position.
• Sell Cash to Currency Chest
The Vault Teller can use this screen to sell cash to the Central Bank from the vault after
all the Tellers have sold the additional cash to the Vault Teller.
• Buy Cash from Vault
The Teller can use the Buy Cash from Vault screen to get cash from the vault.
• Sell Cash to Vault
The Teller can use the Sell Cash to Vault screen to sell cash to the vault. It is used only
when the cash held exceeds the limit set at the template level for any currency.
• Buy Cash from Till
The Teller can use this screen to transfer cash from another Teller in case of insufficient
funds available in the till to perform the customer cash transactions.
• Sell Cash to Till
The Teller can use the Sell Cash to Till screen to transfer cash to another Teller's Till in
case of excess funds available in the Till.
• Denomination Exchange
The Teller can use the Denomination Exchange screen to exchange the currency
denominations.
3-1
Chapter 3
Buy TC from Agent
2. On the Buy TC from Agent screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
TC Amount Select the currency from the drop-down values, and specify
the TC Amount.
Issuer Code Click the search icon, and select the issuer code from the list
of values.
Note:
The list of values provides the issuer codes
maintained in the Issuer Code Maintenance
screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified issuer code.
3-2
Chapter 3
Buy TC from Agent
Field Description
Narrative Displays the narrative as Buy TC From Agent, and it can be
modified.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission, the TC position
(TC Inflow) is updated to the branch vault (vault ID that is opened) for the
combination of Issuer code, TC Currency, TC Denom Code, and Series.
In addition, during transaction completion, the system creates individual TC
records for the combination of TC Currency, Issuer Code, TC Denom Code,
Series, and TC Number with TC status as Null.
3-3
Chapter 3
Buy TC from Head Office
Field Description
Denom Code Specify the TC denomination code from the list of values.
Currency Displays the default TC Currency.
Series Specify the series of TC denomination code that needs to be
purchased from the agent.
Note:
This field accepts alphanumeric
values.
2. On the Buy TC from HO screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
3-4
Chapter 3
Buy TC from Vault
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
TC Amount Select the currency from the drop-down values, and specify the TC
Amount.
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the issuer codes maintained in
the Issuer Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified issuer code.
Narrative Displays the narrative as Buy TC From HO, and it can be modified.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission, the TC position
(TC Inflow) is updated to the branch vault (vault ID that is opened) for the
combination of Issuer code, TC Currency, TC Denom Code, and Series.
In addition, during transaction completion, the system creates individual TC
records for the combination of TC Currency, Issuer Code, TC Denom Code,
Series, and TC Number with TC status as Null.
3-5
Chapter 3
Buy TC from Vault
2. On the Buy TC from Vault screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
TC Amount Select the currency from the drop-down values, and specify
the TC Amount.
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the issuer codes
maintained in the Issuer Code Maintenance
screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified issuer code.
Narrative Displays the narrative as Buy TC From Vault, and it can be
modified.
3-6
Chapter 3
Buy TC from Vault
Field Description
Denom Code Specify the TC denomination code from the list of values.
Currency Displays the default TC Currency.
Series Specify the series of the TC denomination code that needs to be
purchased from the Vault.
Note:
The list of values contains the valid TC series that are
available with Vault. On click of LOV, the search criterion
field will have Series, and the result criterion will display
the Series and Start Number.
Note:
Based on the series selected, the system will populate
the start number available for the combination of
Currency, TC Denom Code, and Series.
End Number Displays the end number, which is the sum of the start number and
the count.
TC Amount Displays the TC Amount, which is the product of the denomination
and the count.
Total TC Amount Displays the total TC amount along with the currency.
Denomination Amount Displays the denomination amount along with the currency.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission, the TC position
(TC Outflow) is updated to the branch vault, and TC Inflow is updated to the
logged-in Teller for the combination of Issuer Code, TC Currency, TC denom
Code, and Series to the extent of TC denomination units being purchased.
In addition, during transaction completion, the system updates the TC status as
Unused for the combination of TC Currency, Issuer Code, TC Denom Code,
Series, and TC Number.
3-7
Chapter 3
Return TC to Vault
2. On the Return TC to Vault screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
TC Amount Select the TC currency from the drop-down values, and
specify the TC Amount.
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the HO code of the
logged-in branch and the issuer codes maintained
in the Issuer Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified Issuer Code.
Narrative Displays the narrative as Sell TC to Vault, and it can be
modified.
3-8
Chapter 3
Return TC to Vault
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the TC position (TC outflow) is decreased for logged-in Teller
ID, and the TC Position (TC Inflow) is incremented for Vault ID of the branch. It is
performed for the combination of Issuer Code, TC Currency, TC Denom code, and Series
to the extent of TC denomination units being purchased.
In addition, during transaction completion, the system updates the TC Status as Null for
the combination of TC Currency, Issuer Code, TC Denom Code, Series, and TC Number.
• Add TC Denominations to Return TC
You can add the denomination details for the TC in the TC Denominations data
segment.
Field Description
Denom Code Specify the TC denomination code from the list of values.
Currency Displays the default TC currency.
Series Specify the series of the TC Denom Code that is being purchased from
the agent.
Count Specify the count of the TC that needs to be sold.
3-9
Chapter 3
Return TC to HO
Field Description
Start Number Display the starting number of the series.
Note:
Based on the series selected, the system
will populate the Start Number available
for the combination of Currency, TC
Denom Code, and Series.
End Number Displays the end number, which is the sum of start number and the
count.
TC Amount Displays the TC Amount, which is the product of the denomination and
the count.
Total TC Amount Displays the total TC amount along with the currency.
Denomination Amount Displays the denomination amount along with the currency.
3.5 Return TC to HO
The Return TC to HO screen is used to sell TC to the HO, and only a Vault Teller can
access this screen.
To sell TC to the HO:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Till-Vault Operations, click
Return TC to HO or specify Return TC to HO in the search icon bar and select
the screen.
The Sale TC to HO screen is displayed.
2. On the Sale TC to HO screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3-10
Chapter 3
Buy Cash from Currency Chest
Field Description
TC Amount Select the TC currency from the drop-down values, and specify the
TC Amount.
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the HO code of the logged-in
branch and the issuer codes maintained in the Issuer
Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified Issuer Code.
Narrative Displays the narrative as Return TC to HO, and it can be modified.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission, the TC position
(TC outflow) is decreased for the Vault ID for the combination of Issuer Code,
TC Currency, TC Denom code, and Series to the extent of TC denomination
units being purchased.
3-11
Chapter 3
Buy Cash from Currency Chest
2. On the Buy Cash from Currency Chest screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Total Required Cash Specify the total cash that you need to buy from Currency
Chest.
Note:
By default, the system displays the local currency of
the branch. You can select another currency from
the drop-down values in which cash needs to be
bought from the currency chest.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash
balance of the Vault Teller is updated successfully.
3-12
Chapter 3
Sell Cash to Currency Chest
2. On the Sell Cash to Currency Chest screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Total Required Cash Specify the total cash that you need to sell to the Currency Chest.
Note:
By default, the system displays the local currency of the
branch. The user can select another currency from the
drop-down values in which cash needs to be sold to the
currency chest.
3-13
Chapter 3
Buy Cash from Vault
Field Description
Narrative Displays the default narrative Sell Cash to Currency
Chest, and it can be modified.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash
balance of the Vault Teller is updated successfully.
2. On the Buy Cash from Vault screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3-14
Chapter 3
Sell Cash to Vault
Field Description
Total Required Cash Specify the total cash that you need to transfer from the vault to the
till of the logged-in Teller.
Note:
By default, the system displays the local currency of the
branch. The user can select another currency from the
drop-down values in which cash needs to be transferred
from the vault.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Transfer Cash from Vault, and it
can be modified.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the accounting entries (for
example, Dr Teller Cash GL & Cr Vault Cash GL) for the transaction will be
handed off to FCUBS based on the settlement definition maintained for the
function code. Also, the cash positions of the Teller are increased and the Vault
Teller is decreased successfully.
If the cash position of the Vault Teller is less than the total cash requested by
the Teller:
• The system displays an error message
• The Teller needs to perform this transaction after the vault is replenished
sufficiently
3-15
Chapter 3
Sell Cash to Vault
2. On the Sell Cash to Vault screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Total Required Cash Specify the total cash that you need to transfer to the vault
from the till of the logged-in Teller.
Note:
By default, the system displays the local currency of
the branch. The user can select another currency
from the drop-down values in which cash needs to
be transferred to the vault.
3-16
Chapter 3
Buy Cash from Till
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the accounting entries (for
example, Dr Vault Cash GL & Cr Teller Cash GL) for the transaction will be
handed off to FCUBS based on the settlement definition maintained for the
function code. Also, the cash balance of the Teller is decreased and the Vault
Teller is increased successfully.
2. On the Buy Cash from Till screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3-17
Chapter 3
Sell Cash to Till
Field Description
Teller ID Displays the Teller ID from where the cash needs to be
transferred.
Total Required Cash Specify the total cash that you need to transfer from the
specified Teller ID to the till of logged-in Teller.
Note:
By default, the system displays the local currency of
the branch. You can select another currency from
the drop-down values in which cash needs to be
transferred.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Transfer Cash from Till, and
it can be modified.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash
balance of both the Tellers is updated successfully.
3-18
Chapter 3
Sell Cash to Till
2. On the Sell Cash to Till screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Teller ID Displays the Teller ID from which the cash needs to be transferred.
Total Required Cash Specify the total cash that you need to transfer to the specified
Teller ID from the till of the logged-in Teller.
Note:
By default, the system displays the local currency of the
branch. The user can select another currency from the
drop-down values in which the cash needs to be
transferred.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Transfer Cash to Till, and it can
be modified.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash balance of both the
Tellers is updated successfully.
3-19
Chapter 3
Denomination Exchange
2. On the Denomination Exchange screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
Transaction Currency Specify the currency for which the denominations are to be
exchanged.
3-20
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash balance of both the
Tellers is updated successfully.
3-21
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
2. On the Inter Branch Transaction Request screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
New Click this button to create a new inter branch transaction and
generate the inter branch request reference number.
Query Click Query to enable the field Inter Branch Request
Reference.
3-22
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
Field Description
Inter Branch Request The following conditions apply to this field:
Reference • If you click New, the request reference number for the
inter branch transaction is displayed.
• If you click Query, select the inter branch request
reference from the list of values. The list of values fetches
only the reference numbers that are saved and not
submitted.
Transaction Amount Select the transaction currency from the option list. Specify the
amount that needs to be transferred.
Requesting Branch Displays the branch code of requesting branch.
Requesting Branch Displays the name of the branch code specified.
Description
To Branch Select the branch code to which the request is being made.
To Branch Description Displays the name of the specified To Branch.
Request Type Select from the following request types:
• Cash Delivery - when the branch is in short of cash.
• Cash Pickup - when the branch has excess cash.
Request Date Displays the current date as the request date.
Cash Delivery/Pickup Specify the date of cash delivery/pickup.
Date
Note:
By default, the current system date is displayed,
and it can be modified.
Request Status Select the status of the request. The drop-down list shows the
following options:
• Request - to create a new request.
• Accept - to accept a request received.
• Pending - system-defined status indicating that the
request has been sent but not accepted.
• Initiated - system-defined status indicating that the
request has been accepted and initiated.
• Liquidated - system-defined status indicating that the
request has been processed and liquidated.
Narrative Specify the remarks, if any.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
The request is sent to the receiving/remitting branch for further processing.
3-23
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
Note:
The destination branch can access the same screen to accept or reject
the request.
2. On the Inter Branch Transaction Input screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3-24
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
Field Description
Inter Branch Request Select the request reference from the list of values.
Reference
Query Click Query to fetch and populate the request details.
From Branch Displays the branch code of From Branch. The following values are
applied based on the request type in the Inter Branch Transaction
Request screen:
• For Cash Delivery, the To Branch in the Inter Branch
Transaction Request screen is populated in this field.
• For Cash Pickup, the Requesting Branch in the Inter
Branch Transaction Request screen is populated in this field.
From Branch Description Displays the description of the From Branch.
From Vault ID Displays the Vault user of the specified From Branch.
To Branch Displays the branch code of To Branch. The following values are
applied based on the request type in the Inter Branch Transaction
Request screen:
• For Cash Delivery, the Requesting Branch in the Inter
Branch Transaction Request screen is populated in this field.
• For Cash Pickup, the To Branch in Inter Branch
Transaction Request screen is populated in this field.
To Branch Description Displays the description of specified To Branch.
To Vault ID Displays the Vault user of To Branch.
Transaction Amount Displays the transaction currency and transaction amount based on
the request reference.
Requested Date Displays the date on which the transaction is requested.
Narrative Specify the remarks, if any.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
The request is sent to the requesting branch for further processing.
Note:
The request status in the Inter Branch Transaction Request screen will be
internally updated to Initiated for the related request reference number. In
addition, the system will post the accounting entries (for example, Dr Sending
Branch Inter Branch Transit GL & Cr Sending Branch Vault GL) for the Inter
Branch Input transaction as per the settlement definition maintained for the
function code, and advice will be generated on transaction completion.
3-25
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
2. On the Inter Branch Transaction Liquidation screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Inter Branch Request Select the request reference from the list of values.
Reference
Query Click Query to fetch and populate the request details.
From Branch Displays the branch code of From Branch.
3-26
Chapter 3
Inter Branch Transactions
Field Description
From Branch Displays the description of the From Branch.
Description
From Vault ID Displays the Vault user of the specified From Branch.
To Branch Displays the branch code of To Branch.
To Branch Description Displays the description of specified To Branch.
To Vault ID Displays the Vault user of To Branch.
Transaction Amount Displays the transaction currency and transaction amount
based on the request reference.
Requested Date Displays the date on which the transaction is requested.
Narrative Specify the remarks, if any.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Click Submit.
The system updates the request reference as Liquidated in the Inter Branch
Transaction Request screen for the related request reference.
Note:
The system will post the accounting entries (for example, Dr Receiving Branch
Vault Transit GL & Cr Sending Branch Inter Branch Transit GL) for the Inter
Branch Input transaction as per the settlement definition maintained for the
function code.
As the liquidation transaction accounting involves two different branches, the
corresponding IB position entries will be processed by FCUBS accordingly.
3-27
4
Customer Transactions
The Teller can use Customer Transactions to perform financial transactions for customer
accounts.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Cash Deposit
The Cash Deposit screen is used to deposit the cash in a CASA. Cash can be deposited
in either account currency or any foreign currency that is allowed.
• Cash Withdrawal
The Cash Withdrawal screen is used to withdraw funds from the CASA account of the
customer.
• Cheque Withdrawal
The Cheque Withdrawal screen is used to withdraw cash from the CASA account of the
customer against the in-house cheque.
• FX Sale Against Account
The Foreign Exchange (FX) Sale Against Account screen is used to sell the foreign
currency from the branch through the CASA account.
• FX Sale Against Walk-in
The FX Sale Against Walk-in screen is used to sell a foreign currency to a walk-in
customer in return for the equivalent amount received in the local currency.
• FX Purchase Against Account
The FX Purchase Against Account screen is used to purchase foreign currency from
the branch through the CASA account.
• FX Purchase Against Walk-in
The FX Purchase Against Walk-in screen is used to buy a foreign currency from a walk-
in customer in return for the equivalent amount in the local currency.
• Close Out Withdrawal
The Close Out Withdrawal screen to initiate an account closure and close the CASA
account by either dispersing the cash to the customer or by account transfer or by issuing
Bankers Cheque.
• Close Out Withdrawal by Multi-Mode
The Close Out Withdrawal by Multi Mode screen is used to close the CASA account by
multi-mode payout options, which include cash, account transfer, and BC. This screen
can be used only when the closeout withdrawal needs to be done in multiple payout
modes.
• Safe Deposit Rental By Cash
The Teller can use the Safe Deposit Rental By Cash screen to make payment by cash
for the safe deposit locker of the customer.
• Recurring Deposit Payment by Cash
The Recurring Deposit Payment by Cash screen is used to make payment for the
Recurring Deposit (RD) account of the customer by cash.
4-1
Chapter 4
Cash Deposit
4-2
Chapter 4
Cash Deposit
2. On the Cash Deposit screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify a valid account number for the customer. When you press
the Tab key, the corresponding account information will be displayed
in the Customer Information widget.
Note:
In addition, you can use Oracle Banking Virtual
Accounts. These Virtual Accounts are used as a routing
account to credit the underlying physical account.
The system displays an override or error message on the
tab out of Account Number based on the account
dormancy parameters.
4-3
Chapter 4
Cash Deposit
Field Description
Transaction Amount Displays the local currency of the branch. You can also select other
transaction currencies from the drop-down values.
Specify the transaction amount that needs to be credited to the
customer account.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate, if it is needed to perform the
Rate transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction currency
into account currency and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
4-4
Chapter 4
Cash Deposit
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system
in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
Once you submit the transaction, the system validates the following:
• Mandatory fields
• Allowed minimum/maximum limit amount for the user ID
• Allowed currency for Teller user ID
• Till balance and branch breaching limit
• Function code preferences
• Duplicate transactions
If any of the validation fails, the system will prompt appropriate information, warning, or
error message. For more information, refer to the following steps:
• If an information message is prompted, click OK to confirm and complete the
transaction.
• If a warning message is prompted, the system will move the transaction for
authorization. Once approved, the transaction is moved to Teller Electronic Journal
for completion. Refer to authorization procedures to know more about authorization
processing.
• If any validation error is prompted, you need to update the details to fix the error and
re-submit the transaction.
• If any other error message is prompted, the transaction is discarded and does not get
saved.
• If you click Close or Cancel after specifying the transaction details, then the data will
not persist.
When the Teller completes the transaction, the corresponding Teller's cash position is
updated.
The Transaction Completed Successfully information message is displayed.
4-5
Chapter 4
Cash Deposit
You can view or waive the computed charges. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charges in transaction currency (TCY) and
branch local currency (LCY).
Detailed View Displays the following charge details of each charge code:
• Charge Code
• Currency
• Charge Amount
• Waiver
• Charge By Cash
• Charge TCY
• Charge LCY
• Basis
• Min Charge
• Max Charge
• Price Rule Id
• Credit Account
• Debit Account
Charge Code The system defaults the charge components applicable to the
transaction.
Currency Displays the currency in which the charge has to be deducted.
4-6
Chapter 4
Cash Withdrawal
Field Description
Charge Amount Displays the charge amount that needs to be deducted for the
corresponding charge component.
Note:
The charge amount can be modified
only if the field is enabled in the
Function Code Preferences
screen. The modified charge
amount will be validated against the
minimum and maximum charge
amount that can be configured at
the Charge Maintenance screen.
When an individual charge amount
is modified, the system will
recalculate all the dependent
charges.
Note:
When the Waiver is enabled, the
value under Charge Amount will be
waived and no charge accounting
entries will be passed. The charge
waiver can be enabled at individual
charge level without impacting other
linked charges. The minimum
charge amount configured at the
charge maintenance level, will not
be validated when the charge is
waived.
4-7
Chapter 4
Cash Withdrawal
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Customer Transaction, click
Cash Withdrawal or specify Cash Withdrawal in the search icon bar and select
the screen.
The Cash Withdrawal screen is displayed.
2. On the Cash Withdrawal screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
4-8
Chapter 4
Cash Withdrawal
Field Description
Account Number Specify a valid customer account number.
Note:
When you press the Tab key, the corresponding account
information will be displayed in the Customer
Information widget.
The system displays an override or error message on the
tab out of Account Number based on the account
dormancy parameters.
Transaction Amount Displays the local currency of the branch. You can also select
another currency from the drop-down values. Specify the
transaction amount that needs to be debited from the customer
account.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform the
Rate transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction currency
into account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
4-9
Chapter 4
Cash Withdrawal
Field Description
Account Amount Displays the transaction amount converted in terms of account
amount based on the exchange rate.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system
in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the cash is withdrawn successfully from the customer account. For more
information on transaction submission and validations, refer to Step 5 in
Cash Deposit.
4-10
Chapter 4
Cheque Withdrawal
2. On the Cheque Withdrawal screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
4-11
Chapter 4
Cheque Withdrawal
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify a valid account number for the customer.
Note:
When you press the Tab key, the corresponding
account information will be displayed in the
Customer Information widget.
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Transaction Amount Displays the local currency of the branch. You can also select
another currency from the drop-down list. Specify the
transaction amount that needs to be debited from the
customer account.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number of the customer account as
provided by the Customer.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Cheque Date Select the date on which the cheque has been issued from the
calendar option.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
4-12
Chapter 4
Cheque Withdrawal
Field Description
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Reject Code Select the reject code from the list of values, which are
maintained in the Reject Code Maintenance screen.
Note:
If the cheque withdrawal transaction needs to be
rejected, you can reject it by specifying the
appropriate reject code in this field. The transaction
can be rejected for one of the following reasons:
• Insufficient funds
• Signature mismatch
• Stale cheque
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
4-13
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Account
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the cash is withdrawn successfully against the customer cheque. For
more information on transaction submission and validations, refer to
Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
4-14
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Account
2. On the FX Sale Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
4-15
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Account
Field Description
Account Number Specify the CASA account to be debited for the foreign
currency sale from the adjacent option list.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Amount Sold Specify the currency and amount sold against the CASA
account. You can select the appropriate code from the
adjoining option list that displays all the currency codes
maintained in the system. The system also displays the
amount that is being sold.
Allow Denom Variance Select if the denomination-wise variance needs to be applied
for the transaction.
Note:
If the parameter at the function code indicator is set
as Y, this option will be selected by default and it
can be modified. If the parameter at the function
code indicator is set as N, then this option will be
disabled.
Beneficiary Name Displays the name of the beneficiary customer based on the
account number selected.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the type of identification provided by the customer from
the drop-down list.
Identification Number Specify the identification number provided by the customer.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate, if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
4-16
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Account
Field Description
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
(sale) currency into account currency and it can be modified.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Amount Received Displays the amount received and currency from the CASA
account.
Note:
The currency of the amount received defaults from
the CASA account currency. The amount received
will be calculated based on the Amount Sold and
the Exchange Rate. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount which is computed by the
system in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the FX Out Denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4-17
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Walk-in
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the foreign currency cash is withdrawn and the equivalent account
amount is debited. For more information on transaction submission and
validations, refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
2. On the FX Sale Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
4-18
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Walk-in
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Amount Sold Select the applicable currency from the drop-down list and specify
the amount that needs to be sold to the walk-in customer.
Currency Received Select the currency that you have received from the customer in
return for the currency sold. You can select the appropriate code
from the adjoining option list that displays all the currency codes
maintained in the system.
Allow Denom Variance Select if the denomination-wise variance needs to be applied for the
transaction.
Note:
If the parameter at function code indicator is set as Y,
this option will be selected by default, and it can be
modified. If the parameter at the function code indicator
is set as N, then this option will be disabled.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
4-19
Chapter 4
FX Sale Against Walk-in
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction currency
into account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Amount Received Displays the amount received and currency from the customer.
Note:
The currency of the amount received will be defaulted
from Currency Received. The amount received will be
calculated based on the Amount Sold and the
Exchange Rate. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system
in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the FX In Denomination details. For information on the fields in the FX In
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Specify the FX Out Denomination details. For information on the fields in the FX
Out Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
4-20
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Account
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the teller cash
position to the equivalent of "Sold currency" is deducted, and "Received
currency" is incremented. For more information on transaction submission and
validations, refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
4-21
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Account
2. On the FX Purchase Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
4-22
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Account
Field Description
Account Number Specify the CASA account number to be credited for the foreign
currency purchase.
Note:
In addition, you can use Oracle Banking Virtual
Accounts. These Virtual Accounts are used as a routing
account to credit the underlying physical account.
The system displays an override or error message on the
tab out of Account Number based on the account
dormancy parameters.
Amount Bought Select the applicable currency from the drop-down list, and specify
the amount that needs to be bought from the customer.
Allow Denom Variance Select if the denomination-wise variance needs to be applied for the
transaction.
Note:
If the parameter at the function code indicator is set as Y,
this option will be selected by default, and it can be
modified. If the parameter at function code indicator is set
as N, then this option will be disabled.
Beneficiary Name Displays the name of the beneficiary customer based on the
account number provided.
Beneficiary Address 1 to Displays the address of the beneficiary.
Beneficiary Address 4
Identification Type Select the type of identification provided by the customer from the
drop-down list.
Identification Number Specify the identification number provided by the customer.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform the
Rate transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
4-23
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Account
Field Description
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction currency
into account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Amount Paid Displays the amount paid and currency to the CASA account.
Note:
The currency of the amount paid is defaulted from the
account currency. The Amount Paid will be calculated
based on the Amount Bought and the Exchange Rate.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system
in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the FX In Denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4-24
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Walk-in
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the teller's cash
position gets incremented based on the amount bought.
In addition, the corresponding foreign currency cash is deposited for an
equivalent amount of credit in the customer's account. For more information on
transaction submission and validations, refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
4-25
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Walk-in
2. On the FX Purchase Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Amount Bought Select the applicable currency from the drop-down list, and
specify the amount bought from the walk-in customer.
Currency Paid Select the currency that you have paid to the walk-in customer.
Note:
You can select the appropriate code from the list of
values that displays all the currency codes
maintained in the system.
Note:
If the parameter at function code indicator is set as
Y, this option will be selected by default, and it can
be modified. If the parameter at the function code
indicator is set as N, then this option will be
disabled.
4-26
Chapter 4
FX Purchase Against Walk-in
Field Description
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
currency into account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Amount Paid Displays the amount paid and currency to the customer.
Note:
The currency of the amount paid is defaulted from
the received currency. The Amount Paid will be
calculated based on the Amount Bought and the
Exchange Rate. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
4-27
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the FX In Denomination details. For information on the fields in the FX In
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Specify the FX Out Denomination details. For information on the fields in the FX
Out Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the teller cash position is updated based on the currency of the Amount
Bought and the Amount Paid fields. For more information on
transaction submission and validations, refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
4-28
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Customer Transaction, click Close
Out Withdrawal or specify Close Out Withdrawal in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The Close Out Withdrawal screen is displayed.
2. On the Close Out Withdrawal screen, specify fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Customer Account Specify the account number for which the account closure to be
requested.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message on the
tab out of Account Number based on the account
dormancy parameters.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
4-29
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission, it
will verify if IC liquidation is completed for the account. Once the IC
liquidation is done, the transaction details are handed off to the CASA
module in the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the account closure
process. During account closure process, the closure amount will be
parked in the intermediary suspense GL specified during transaction
request handoff.
Maintain Close mode as CASH and linked product as ZRCD in Account
Closing Maintenance (STDCLSMD) in FCUBS. This maintenance will
ensure the funds are parked to the respective suspense GL during the
account closure process at FCUBS.
4. Click Query.
The Close Out Withdrawal - Query screen is displayed.
5. On the Close Out Withdrawal screen, specify fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Transaction Reference Specify the transaction reference number for which the closure
Number is initiated.
Customer Account Displays the customer account number.
Account Amount Displays the account balance in account currency.
4-30
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
Field Description
Close Mode Select the close mode from the following drop-down values:
• Account
For more information, refer to Figure 4-11
• Cash
For more information, refer to Figure 4-12
• Bankers Cheque
For more information, refer to Figure 4-13
Narrative Displays the default narrative Close Out Withdrawal and it
can be modified.
On the Close Out Withdrawal by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Transaction Reference Displays the transaction reference number for which the closure is
Number initiated.
Close Account Displays the customer account number.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message on the
tab out of Account Number based on the account
dormancy parameters.
4-31
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
Table 4-11 (Cont.) Close Out Withdrawal by Account Transfer - Field Description
Field Description
Credit Account Specify the account number to which the funds need to be
transferred during the account closure.
Credit Account Branch Displays the branch code of the offset account.
Credit Account Name Displays the name of the offset account.
Credit Account Amount Displays the offset account amount along with account currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate based on the Account Currency and
Offset Account Currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Close Out Withdrawal, and it can
be modified.
On the Close Out Withdrawal by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Transaction Reference Displays the transaction reference number for which the
Number closure is initiated.
4-32
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
Field Description
Customer Account Displays the account number for which the account closure is
to be requested.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate based on the account currency
and offset account currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4-33
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal
On the Close Out Withdrawal by Bankers Cheque screen, specify the fields. For
more information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Transaction Reference Displays the transaction reference number for which the
Number closure is initiated.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Account Number Displays the account number for which the account closure is
to be requested.
Account Amount Displays the account balance in account currency.
Close Mode Displays the close mode as By Bankers Cheque.
Issue Branch Displays the issuing branch of the banker's cheque.
BC Amount Displays the account currency and account balance. You can
also modify the account currency.
Instrument Number Specify the instrument number.
MICR Number Specify the MICR number.
Payee Name Specify the payee name.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the payee.
Address Line 4
4-34
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal by Multi-Mode
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
currency into account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4-35
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal by Multi-Mode
2. On the Close Out Withdrawal by Multi Mode screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Close Account Specify the account number, which needs to be closed.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Fetch Balance Click Fetch Balance to fetch and display the account amount.
Account Amount Displays the account amount.
Payout Type Select the payout type from the following drop-down values:
• Account – If this option is selected, the user needs to
specify the Offset Account, to which the transfer is to be
made. Based on the specified offset account number, the
system will default the Offset Branch and Offset
Currency fields.
• Cash – If this option is selected, the user needs to
disburse the cash in the account currency.
• Bankers Cheque - If this option is selected, either the
field Instrument Number is populated or the teller can
input the value. On submission, the system will validate
the instrument number if inputted or derive the instrument
number in case of a null value. In addition, the user needs
to capture the BC-related details in the Bankers Cheque
Details data segment. This data segment is mandatory
only if the Payout Type is selected as Bankers Cheque.
4-36
Chapter 4
Close Out Withdrawal by Multi-Mode
Table 4-14 (Cont.) Close Out Withdrawal by Multi Mode - Field Description
Field Description
Percentage Specify the amount of redemption for the payout type selected.
Note:
Based on the percentage input, the system will
derive the amount to be paid out.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Payout Type is
selected as Bankers Cheque.
Issuing Branch Displays the branch code of the specified account number.
Offset Account Specify the account number to which the payout amount
needs to be transferred.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Payout Type is
selected as Account.
Offset Branch Displays the branch of the specified offset account number.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Payout Type is
selected as Account.
Offset Currency Displays the currency of the specified offset account number.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Payout Type is
selected as Account.
4-37
Chapter 4
Safe Deposit Rental By Cash
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission,
the transaction details are handed off to the CASA module in the
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the account closure process.
If the account balance is credited to an intermediary bridge GL, the
transaction status will be changed from Pending to Completed.
Based on the payout options, the corresponding transaction will be
completed successfully.
4-38
Chapter 4
Safe Deposit Rental By Cash
2. On the Safe Deposit Rental By Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Deposit Locker Specify the deposit locker number. When you press the Tab key, the
customer details and deposit locker details will be displayed in the
Customer Information widget.
Rental Amount Select the rental amount currency and specify the amount.
Note:
By default, the rental currency is displayed as locker
currency. If the Multi-Currency Configuration at
Function Code indicator level is set as Y, it can be
modified, and if it is N, then the default value cannot be
modified.
4-39
Chapter 4
Safe Deposit Rental By Cash
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is set
as Y.
Account Amount Displays the rental amount in locker account currency. This amount
will be derived based on the Rental Amount and Exchange Rate.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Narrative Displays the narrative as Safe Deposit Rental By Cash, and it can
be modified.
4-40
Chapter 4
Recurring Deposit Payment by Cash
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the system will
hand off the details to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system to create a
‘Payment’ transaction in the SD module. After the handoff status is successful
in the Oracle Banking Branch, the system will update the transaction status as
Completed and update the Till cash position (by increasing the till balance).
2. On the Recurring Deposit Payment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
4-41
Chapter 4
Recurring Deposit Payment by Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
RD Account Specify a valid RD account number. When you press the Tab
key, the corresponding account information will be displayed in
the Customer Information widget.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Note:
The user can select another currency from the drop-
down values.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
currency into account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
4-42
Chapter 4
F23C Tax Payment by Cash
Field Description
Account Amount Displays the transaction amount converted in terms of account
amount based on the exchange rate.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash is
withdrawn successfully from the customer account. For more information on
transaction submission and validations, refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
4-43
Chapter 4
F23C Tax Payment by Cash
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Customer Transaction, click
F23C Tax Payment - Cash or specify F23C Tax Payment - Cash in the search
icon bar and select the screen.
The F23C Tax Payment By Cash screen is displayed.
2. On the F23C Tax Payment By Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Reference Number Type Select the reference number types from the drop-down list.
The drop-down list shows the following values:
• Reference Number Available
• Reference Number Not Available
Reference Number Specify the reference number of the payment provided by the
Public Authority.
Office or Institute Code Specify the office or institute code that receives the payment.
Office or Institute Sub Specify the office or institute subcode that receives the
code payment.
Litigation Specify the kind of litigation.
For a Total Amount Displays the total tax amount.
Total Charge Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system in the local currency of the branch.
4-44
Chapter 4
F23C Tax Payment by Cash
Table 4-17 (Cont.) F23C Tax Payment By Cash Screen - Field Description
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate based on the Account Currency
and Offset Account Currency.
Payment Amount Displays the amount paid by the customer.
Note:
The currency of the amount paid defaults from the
received currency.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as F23 Tax by Cash, and it can
be modified.
4. On the Payment Data Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Tax Code Specify the Tax Code.
Amount Specify the tax amount.
Beneficiary Code Specify the beneficiary institute code.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
7. After you specify the Reference Number, click Pickup.
The system defaults the Elaboration Date in the section Reference Number Available
with the current system date. In case you do not specify the Reference Number, then
the Principal Fiscal Code needs to be specified. After which the system defaults the
4-45
Chapter 4
F23C Tax Payment by Cash
Elaboration Date in the section Reference Number Not Available with the
current system date. It then adds up the Amounts in the Payment Data Details
block and defaults the sum in the For a total Amount field.
The system posts the following accounting entries on save and authorization of the
record:
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission,
the deposit of tax amount is completed successfully.
4-46
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
2. On the F24C Payment Details screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Total Tax Amount Displays the total tax amount.
Payment Amount Displays the amount to pay.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as F24 Tax by Cash, and it can be
modified.
Total Charge Displays the total charge.
3. Specify the details in the F24 Tax – By Cash segment. For information on the fields
based on the value selected for the Form Type, refer to the table.
Table 4-22 F24 Tax by Cash - Form Types and their References
4-47
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Table 4-22 (Cont.) F24 Tax by Cash - Form Types and their References
On selection of an appropriate value from the Form Type, only the corresponding
tab will be enabled for input. For example, if you select F24 Standard as the Form
Type then only the tab F24 Standard will be enabled and all other tabs will be
disabled. The Principal Fiscal Code needs to be specified.
4. After entering all the form details, click Refresh in the F24 Payment Details.
The system adds up the Amounts and defaults the sum in the Payment Amount
field. The system posts the following accounting entries on save and authorization
of the record.
The system validates only the data format of the fields specified. If any such
validations fail, the system displays an appropriate error message. If you maintain
more than the specified number of rows in any of the below blocks, then the
system displays an appropriate error message. The following list shows the
number of rows, which can be maintained for each Form Type:
4-48
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
If the computed value for Payment Amount field value is less than or equal to 0, the
system displays an appropriate error message. If the Principal Fiscal Code and
Secondary Fiscal Code fields have a value of 16 characters that is for non-individual
customers, the system validates the last character in the value as per the checksum
algorithm for Fiscal Code. If the validation fails, then the system displays an appropriate
error message. In the case of individual customers, where the Principal Fiscal Code
and Secondary Fiscal Code field has a value of 11 characters, the system validates the
last character in the value as per the checksum algorithm for a VAT number. If the
validation fails, then the system displays an appropriate error message.
5. Once Pickup is completed, click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission, the deposit of
tax amount is completed successfully.
4-49
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Field Description
Form Type Select the Standard tax category from the drop-down list.
F24 Standard Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Secondary Fiscal Code Specify the secondary fiscal code.
Identity Code Specify the Identity code secondary fiscal code.
Secondary Fiscal Code
Total Final Payment Specify the total amount to be paid.
Different Tax Year Specify if the tax being paid is related to the current year or
not.
4-50
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Field Description
Final Payment Fields The system displays the total tax amount of each segment:
• Tax Institution
• INPS Institution
• Region Institution
• Local Institution
• Insurance Institution
• Other Institution
• Excise
2. Specify the tax details. For information on the fields in the Tax Details, refer to Add Tax
Details.
3. Specify the INPS details. For information on the fields in the INPS, refer to Add INPS
Details.
4. Specify the region details. For information on the fields in the Region, refer to Add
Region Details.
5. Specify the details of the IMU and other local taxes. For information on the fields in the
IMU and Other Local Taxes, refer to Add IMU and Other Local Taxes.
6. Specify the insurance details. For information on the fields in the Insurance Details, refer
to Add Insurance Details.
7. Specify the details of the other bodies. For information on the fields in the Other Bodies,
refer to Add Other Bodies.
8. Specify the excise details. For information on the fields in the Excise, refer to Add Excise
Details.
• Add Tax Details
You can add the details of the tax in the Tax Details segment.
• Add INPS Details
You can add the details of the INPS in the INPS Details segment.
• Add Region Details
You can add the details of the region in the Region segment.
• Add IMU and Other Local Taxes
You can add the details of IMU and other local taxes in the IMU and Other Local Taxes
segment.
• Add Insurance Details
You can add the details of the insurance in the Insurance Details segment.
• Add Other Bodies
You can add the details of the other bodies in the Other Bodies segment.
• Add Excise Details
You can add the details of the excise in the Excise segment.
4-51
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Tax Code Specify the reason.
Instal.Reg/Prov Specify the Instal.Reg/ Prov.
Year Specify the year.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Document Code Specify the document code.
Total Debit Amount (A) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (B) Displays the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (A- Displays the final section amount.
B)
4-52
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Office Specify the office.
Reason Specify the reason.
INPS Office Code Specify the INPS office code.
Period (From) Specify the date from when the amount is paid.
Period (To) Specify the date till when the amount is paid.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Total Debit Amount (C) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (D) Displays the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (C-D) Displays the final section amount.
4-53
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Region Code Specify the region code.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Installment Specify the installment amount.
Year Specify the year.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Total Debit Amount (E) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (F) Displays the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (E- Displays the final section amount.
F)
4-54
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Institution Code/Town Specify the institution/town code.
Code
Late Payment Specify if the payment is late.
Bounding Var. Specify the Bounding Var.
Down Payment Specify the down payment.
Final Payment Specify the final payment.
Building Nr Specify the building number.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Installment Specify the installment amount.
Deduction Specify the deduction amount.
Total Debit Amount (G) Displays the Total Debit Amount.
Building Reference Specify the building reference number.
Number
Total Credit Amount (H) Displays the Total Compensation Amount.
Final Section Amount (G-H) Displays the Final Section Amount.
4-55
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Office Code Specify the office code.
Insurance Number Specify the insurance number.
Insurance Account Code Specify the insurance account code.
Reference Number Specify the reference number.
Reason Specify the reason.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Total Debit Amount (I) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (L) Displays the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (I- Displays the final section amount.
L)
4-56
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Institution Code Specify the institution code.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Reason Specify the reason.
Insurance Reference Specify the insurance reference number.
Number
Period (From) Specify the date from when the amount is paid.
Period (To) Specify the date till when the amount is paid.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Total Debit Amount (M) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (N) Displays the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (M-N) Displays the final section amount.
4-57
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Institution Specify the institution.
Province Specify the province.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Company Identification Specify the company identification number.
Installment Specify the installment amount.
Period/Month Specify the month of tax payment.
Period/Year Specify the year of tax payment.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Total Debit Amount (O) Displays the total debit amount.
Document Code Specify the document code.
Final Section Amount Displays the final section amount.
4-58
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Form Type Select the Simplified tax category from the drop-down list.
F24 Simplified Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
principal fiscal code is 16 characters and
for non-individual customers, this will be
an 11-character VAT number.
4-59
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Field Description
Secondary Fiscal Code Specify the secondary fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
secondary fiscal code is 16 characters
and for non-individual customers, this will
be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Section Specify the section.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Institution Code Specify the institution code.
Late Payment Specify if the payment is late.
Bounding Var. Specify the Bounding Var.
Down Payment Specify the down payment.
Final Payment Specify the final payment.
Building Nr Specify the building number.
Installment Specify the installment amount.
Year Specify the year.
Deduction Specify the deduction amount.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Document Code Specify the document code.
Building Reference Specify the building reference number.
Number
Total Debit Amount (G) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (H) Specify the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (G-H) Displays the final section amount.
4-60
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Table 4-35 F24 Tax By Cash with Elements Identification - Field Description
Field Description
Form Type Select the Elements Identification tax category from the drop-down
list.
F24 Elide Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
principal fiscal code is 16 characters and
for non-individual customers, this will be
an 11-character VAT number.
4-61
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Table 4-35 (Cont.) F24 Tax By Cash with Elements Identification - Field Description
Field Description
Secondary Fiscal Code Specify the secondary fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
secondary fiscal code is 16 characters
and for non-individual customers, this will
be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Type of Vehicle/ Element Specify the vehicle type.
Vehicle/ Element ID Specify the vehicle ID.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Year Specify the year.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Document Code Specify the document code.
Total Debit Amount Displays the total amount to pay.
Final Section Amount Displays the final section amount.
4-62
Chapter 4
F24C Tax Payment By Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Form Type Select the Predefined tax category from the drop-down list.
F24 Predefined Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
principal fiscal code is 16 characters and
for non-individual customers, this will be
an 11-character VAT number.
4-63
Chapter 4
F23 Tax Payment by Account
Field Description
Secondary Fiscal Code Specify the secondary fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
secondary fiscal code is 16 characters
and for non-individual customers, this will
be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Tax Institution Displays the tax Institution.
Payment ID Specify the payment ID.
Amount to Pay Specify the amount to be paid.
Total Debit Amount Displays the total debit amount.
Final Section Amount Displays the final section amount.
4-64
Chapter 4
F23 Tax Payment by Account
2. On the F23 Tax Payment by Account screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Reference Number Type Select the reference number types from the drop-down list. The
drop-down list shows the following values:
• Reference Number Available
• Reference Number Not Available
Reference Number Specify the reference number of the payment provided by the public
authority.
Office or Institute Code Specify the office or institute code that receives the payment.
Office or Institute Sub Specify the office or institute subcode that receives the payment.
code
Litigation Specify the kind of litigation.
For a Total Amount Displays the total tax amount.
Total Charge Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system
in the local currency of the branch.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate based on the Account Currency and
Offset Account Currency.
4-65
Chapter 4
F23 Tax Payment by Account
Field Description
Payment Amount Displays the amount paid by the customer.
Note:
The currency of the amount paid defaults from the
received currency.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as F23 Tax by Account, and it can be
modified.
4. On the Account Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the customer account number from which the tax is
being paid.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
4-66
Chapter 4
F23 Tax Payment by Account
Field Description
Branch Displays the branch code.
Account Description Displays the description of the account number specified.
Account Amount Displays the amount available in the account.
Net Amount Displays the amount, which is the net total amount levied to
the customer.
6. On the Payment Data Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Amount Specify the tax amount.
Beneficiary Code Specify the beneficiary institute code.
7. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
8. After you specify the Reference Number, corresponding fields are displayed for the user
to input the details. Once you specify the Payment Details and click Refresh.
The system computes the total amount, which can be with or without charges.
If the Reference Number is not specified, the relevant fields are displayed for input in the
section Reference Number Not Available. Once you specify the Payment Details and
click Refresh, the system posts the following accounting entries on saving and
authorization of the record:
4-67
Chapter 4
F23 Tax Payment by Account
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission,
the deposit of tax amount is completed successfully.
4-68
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
2. On the F24 Tax Payment By Account screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Total Tax Amount Displays the total tax amount.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as F24 Tax by Account, and it can be
modified.
Total Charge Displays the total charge.
Payment Amount Displays the amount to pay.
4-69
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
4. On the Account Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the customer account number from which the tax is
being paid.
Note:
5. Specify the details in the F24 Tax By Account segment. For information on the
fields based on the value selected for the Form Type, refer to the table.
Table 4-44 F24 Tax By Account - Form Types and their References
4-70
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
On selection of an appropriate value from the Form Type, only corresponding fields of
the form will be displayed for input. For example, if you select F24 Standard as the Form
Type, then only the fields of F24 Standard will be available. The Principal Fiscal Code
needs to be specified.
6. After entering all the form details, click Refresh in the F24 Payment Details.
The system adds up the Amounts and defaults the sum in the Payment Amount field.
The system posts the following accounting entries on save and authorization of the
record.
The system validates only the data format of the fields specified. If any of such
validations fail, the system displays an appropriate error message. If you maintain more
than the specified number of rows in any of the below blocks, then the system displays
an appropriate error message. The following list shows the number of rows, which can be
maintained for each Form Type:
4-71
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
If the computed value for the Payment Amount field value is less than or equal to
0, the system displays an appropriate error message. If the Principal Fiscal Code
and Secondary Fiscal Code fields have a value of 16 characters that is for non-
individual customers the system validates the last character in the value as per the
checksum algorithm for Fiscal Code.
If the validation fails, then the system displays an appropriate error message. In
the case of individual customers, where the Principal Fiscal Code and
Secondary Fiscal Code field has a value of 11 characters, the system validates
the last character in the value as per the checksum algorithm for a VAT number. If
the validation fails, then the system displays an appropriate error message.
7. Once Pickup is completed, click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission,
the deposit of tax amount is completed successfully.
4-72
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Form Type Select the Standard tax category from the drop-down list.
F24 Standard Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
4-73
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Field Description
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed principal fiscal
code is 16 characters and for non-individual customers,
this will be an 11-character VAT number.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed secondary fiscal
code is 16 characters and for non-individual customers,
this will be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the Identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Total Final Payment Specify the total amount to be paid.
Different Tax Year Specify if the tax being paid is related to the current year or not.
Final Payment Fields The system displays the total amount of each segment:
• Tax Institution
• INPS Institution
• Region Institution
• Local Institution
• Insurance Institution
• Other Institution
• Excise
2. Specify the tax details. For information on the fields in the Tax Details, refer to
Add Tax Details.
3. Specify the INPS details. For information on the fields in the INPS, refer to Add
INPS Details.
4. Specify the region details. For information on the fields in the Region, refer to Add
Region Details.
5. Specify the details of the IMU and other local taxes. For information on the fields in
the IMU and Other Local Taxes, refer to Add IMU and Other Local Taxes.
6. Specify the insurance details. For information on the fields in the Insurance
Details, refer to Add Insurance Details.
7. Specify the details of the other bodies. For information on the fields in the Other
Bodies, refer to Add Other Bodies.
8. Specify the excise details. For information on the fields in the Excise, refer to Add
Excise Details.
4-74
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Form Type Select the Simplified tax category from the adjoining drop-down list.
F24 Simplified Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
4-75
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Field Description
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
principal fiscal code is 16 characters and
for non-individual customers, this will be
an 11-character VAT number.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
secondary fiscal code is 16 characters
and for non-individual customers, this will
be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the Identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Section Specify the section.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Institution Code Specify the institution code.
Late Payment Specify if the payment is late.
Bounding Var. Specify the Bounding Var.
Down Payment Specify the down payment.
Final Payment Specify the final payment.
Building Nr Specify the building number.
Installment Specify the installment amount.
Year Specify the year.
Deduction Specify the deduction amount.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Credit Amount Specify the compensation amount.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Document Code Specify the document code.
Building Reference Specify the building reference number.
Number
Total Debit Amount (G) Displays the total debit amount.
Total Credit Amount (H) Specify the total compensation amount.
Final Section Amount (G-H) Displays the final section amount.
4-76
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Table 4-50 F24 Tax By Cash with Elements Identification - Field Description
Field Description
Form Type Select the Elide tax category from the drop-down list.
F24 Elide Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
4-77
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Table 4-50 (Cont.) F24 Tax By Cash with Elements Identification - Field Description
Field Description
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
principal fiscal code is 16 characters and
for non-individual customers, this will be
an 11-character VAT number.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
secondary fiscal code is 16 characters
and for non-individual customers, this will
be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Total Final Payment Specify the total final payment.
Type of Vehicle/ Element Specify the vehicle type.
Vehicle/ Element ID Specify the vehicle ID.
Tax Code Specify the tax code.
Year Specify the year.
Debit Amount Specify the amount to be paid.
Office Code Specify the office code.
Document Code Specify the document code.
Total Debit Amount Displays the total amount to pay.
Final Section Amount Displays the final section amount.
4-78
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Form Type Select the Predefined tax category from the drop-down list.
F24 Predefined Specify the fields.
Elaboration Date Displays the elaboration date.
Principal Fiscal Code Specify the debtor fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
principal fiscal code is 16 characters and
for non-individual customers, this will be
an 11-character VAT number.
4-79
Chapter 4
F24 Tax Payment By Account
Field Description
Secondary Fiscal Code Specify the secondary fiscal code.
Note:
For Individual customers, the allowed
secondary fiscal code is 16 characters
and for non-individual customers, this will
be an 11-character VAT number.
Identity Code Secondary Specify the identity code secondary fiscal code.
Fiscal Code
Erario Institution Displays the Erario Institution.
Payment ID Specify the payment ID.
Amount to Pay Specify the amount to be paid.
Total Debit Amount Displays the total amount to pay.
Final Section Amount Displays the final section amount.
4-80
5
Miscellaneous Transactions
The Teller can use Miscellaneous Transactions to perform GL transactions against a
customer’s CASA account and GL account.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Miscellaneous Customer Debit
The Miscellaneous Customer Debit screen is used to transfer funds from the customer
account to GL.
• Miscellaneous Customer Credit
The Miscellaneous Customer Credit screen is used to transfer funds from GL to the
customer account.
• Miscellaneous GL Debit
The Miscellaneous GL Debit screen is used to debit an amount from a GL account of
the transaction branch and pay out the equivalent amount in cash.
• Miscellaneous GL Credit
The Miscellaneous GL Credit screen is used to credit an amount to a GL account of the
transaction branch by pay-in of equivalent amount in cash.
• Miscellaneous GL Transfer
The Miscellaneous GL Transfer screen is used to transfer the amount from a GL
account to another GL account.
• Miscellaneous Transfer
The Miscellaneous Transfer screen is used to facilitate transfer between the two
different GLs or customer accounts.
5-1
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Customer Debit
2. On the Miscellaneous Customer Debit screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number from which the funds need to be
debited.
Note:
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Account Amount Displays the account currency based on the account number
specified. Specify the amount that needs to be debited from
the account currency.
5-2
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Customer Debit
Field Description
GL Account Specify the GL account to which the funds need to be credited.
Note:
You can also select the appropriate GL account
from the list of values that displays all the valid GL
accounts.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the transaction branch, and it can
be modified.
GL Description Displays the description of the selected GL account number.
GL Currency By default, the account currency is displayed, and it can be
modified.
GL Amount Displays the amount in terms of GL currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
5-3
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Customer Credit
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
currency into GL currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves.
5-4
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Customer Credit
2. On the Miscellaneous Customer Credit screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
5-5
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Customer Credit
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number from which the funds need to be
credited.
Note:
In addition, you can use Oracle Banking Virtual
Accounts. These Virtual Accounts are used as a
routing account to credit the underlying physical
account.
The system displays an override or error message
on the tab out of Account Number based on the
account dormancy parameters.
Account Amount Displays the account currency based on the account number
specified. Specify the amount to be credited from the account
currency.
GL Account Specify the GL account from which the funds need to be
debited.
Note:
You can also select the appropriate GL account
from the list of values that displays all the valid GL
accounts.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the transaction branch and allows
to modify.
GL Currency By default, the account currency is displayed, and it can be
modified.
GL Amount Displays the amount in terms of GL currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
5-6
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Customer Credit
Field Description
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
5-7
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Debit
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the GL account is debited, and the customer account is credited to the
extent of the Account Amount.
2. On the Miscellaneous GL Debit screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
5-8
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Debit
Field Description
GL Account Specify the GL account from which the funds need to be debited.
Note:
You can also select the appropriate GL account from the
list of values that displays all the valid GL accounts.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
By default, the local currency of the branch is displayed.
You can select another currency if required.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform the
Rate transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
5-9
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Credit
Field Description
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash
balance of the Teller is updated successfully.
5-10
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Credit
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Miscellaneous, click Misc GL Credit
or specify Misc GL Credit in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The Miscellaneous GL Credit screen is displayed.
2. On the Miscellaneous GL Credit screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
GL Account Specify the GL account to which the funds need to be credited.
Note:
You can also select the appropriate GL account from the
list of values that displays all the valid GL accounts.
5-11
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Credit
Field Description
GL Amount Displays the branch account currency and allows to modify if
required. It also displays the amount which is credited to the GL
account.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
By default, the local currency of the branch is displayed.
You can select another currency if required.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform the
Rate transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
5-12
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Transfer
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction currency
into GL currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the cash balance of the Teller
gets updated successfully.
5-13
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Transfer
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
From GL Account Specify the GL account to which the funds need to be debited.
Note:
You can also select the appropriate GL account
from the list of values that displays all the valid GL
accounts.
From GL Amount Displays the branch account currency and allows to modify if
required. It also displays the amount, which is debited from the
GL account.
From GL Description Displays the description of the selected GL account number.
GL Currency Displays the branch currency and allows to modify if required.
From GL Branch Click the search icon, and select the From GL Branch from
the list of values.
5-14
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous GL Transfer
Field Description
To GL Account Specify the GL account to which the funds need to be credited.
Note:
You can also select the appropriate GL account
from the list of values that displays all the valid GL
accounts.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
5-15
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Transfer
2. On the Miscellaneous Transfer screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
5-16
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Transfer
Field Description
Function Code Click the search icon, and select the function code from the list of
values, which contains only non-cash transactions.
Currency Click the search icon, and select the currency from the list of values.
Note:
By default, the currency field will default to the local
branch currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
Based on the specified values of Function Code and
Currency, the system populates Debit Account and
Credit Account details. You can also modify the values.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
5-17
Chapter 5
Miscellaneous Transfer
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transfer currency
into transaction currency and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transfer currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
5-18
6
Transfers
The Teller can use Transfers to perform inter-bank transfers, intra-bank transfers, and cross-
border transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Account to Account Transfer
The Account to Account Transfer screen is used to transfer funds from one account to
another account within the bank.
• In-House Cheque Deposit
The In House Cheque Deposit screen is used to capture in-house cheque deposit
transactions for the customers.
• Domestic Transfer Against Account
The Domestic Transfer Against Account screen is used to transfer funds from an
account held with the bank to an account held with another bank, within the same
country.
• Domestic Transfer Against Walk-in
The Domestic Transfer Against Walk-in screen is used to accept cash from the walk-in
customer and transfer funds to the account held with another bank within the same
country.
• International Transfer Against Account
The International Transfer Against Account screen is used to facilitate international
transfer by debiting the account holder of the bank.
• International Transfer Against Walk-in
The International Transfer Against Walk-in screen is used to facilitate international
transfer by accepting cash from the walk-in customer.
6-1
Chapter 6
Account to Account Transfer
2. On the Account Transfer screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Debit Account Specify the customer account from which the funds need to be
debited.
Debit Amount Displays the transaction account currency. Specify the
transaction amount that needs to be debited from the
customer account.
6-2
Chapter 6
Account to Account Transfer
Field Description
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number of the customer account as
provided by the Customer.
Note:
If the cheque number of the customer account is
specified, the cheque status update will be done as
part of the handoff to FLEXCUBE Universal
Banking.
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Cheque Date Click the calendar icon and select the date on which the
cheque has been issued.
Credit Account Specify the account to which the funds need to be credited.
Note:
In addition, you can use Oracle Banking Virtual
Accounts. These Virtual Accounts are used as a
routing account to credit the underlying physical
account.
Credit Account Name Displays the description of the account number specified.
Credit Account Branch Displays the branch code of the account number specified.
Credit Amount Displays the amount in terms of the credit account currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
6-3
Chapter 6
Account to Account Transfer
Field Description
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
account currency into credit account currency and it can be
modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charge (LCY) Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
6-4
Chapter 6
In-House Cheque Deposit
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the UBS for accounting.
6-5
Chapter 6
In-House Cheque Deposit
2. On the In House Cheque Deposit screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Debit Account Specify the account number of the drawer.
Debit Account Name Displays the name of the account.
Debit Account Branch Displays the branch code of the account number specified.
Cheque Amount Specify the currency and amount as mentioned in the cheque.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction
currency into account currency and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
6-6
Chapter 6
In-House Cheque Deposit
Field Description
Total Charges (LCY) Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Reject Code Select the reject code from the list of values, which are
maintained in the Reject Code Maintenance screen.
Note:
If the cheque withdrawal transaction needs to be
rejected, you can reject it by specifying the
appropriate reject code in this field. The transaction
can be rejected for any of the following reasons:
• Insufficient funds
• Signature mismatch
• Stale cheque
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to UBS for accounting.
6-7
Chapter 6
Domestic Transfer Against Account
2. On the Domestic Transfer Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
6-8
Chapter 6
Domestic Transfer Against Account
Field Description
Remitter Account Specify the customer account from which the funds need to be
debited.
Transaction Amount Displays the transaction account currency and it allows to select
from drop-down values. Specify the transaction amount that needs
to be debited from the customer account.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number of the customer account as provided by
the customer.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or Stopped
or Invalid cheque.
Cheque Date Click the calendar icon and select the date on which the cheque has
been issued.
Account Amount Displays the amount in terms of the remitter account currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transaction account
currency into credit account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
6-9
Chapter 6
Domestic Transfer Against Account
Field Description
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Domestic Transfer Against
Account, and it can be modified.
3. Specify the payment details. For information on the fields in the Payment Details
segment, refer to Add Payment Details for Domestic Transfer.
4. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for outgoing payment creation and processing with external
system status as Pending. After the transaction is processed and responded from
the Oracle Banking Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the
transaction from Journal Log and completes the transaction.
Note:
System shall automate the completion of payment transactions from
Journal log, once the ‘Success’ notification is received from Oracle
Banking Payments based on the flag Auto Processing as Y in
TRANSACTION.SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS. (When Auto Processing
is ‘N’, then Maker-Checker-Maker-Maker and when Auto Processing is Y
then Maker-Checker-Maker).
6-10
Chapter 6
Domestic Transfer Against Account
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Remitter Details Specify the fields.
Remitter Name Displays the remitter description based on the remitter account number
specified.
Address Line 1 to Address Displays the remitter address details.
Line 4
Communication Mode Specify the mode of communication for the transaction. The drop-down
values are E-Mail and Phone.
6-11
Chapter 6
Domestic Transfer Against Walk-in
Field Description
Mobile No Specify the mobile number if the mode of communication is selected as
Phone.
Email ID Specify the email address if the mode of communication is selected as
E-Mail.
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Payment Type Select the payment type from the drop-down values.
Beneficiary Bank Code Select the beneficiary bank code from the list of values.
Note:
The LOV display all valid clearing bank
codes maintained in the system.
Beneficiary Bank Name Specify the name of the beneficiary bank. If the beneficiary bank code
is selected, the system displays the description.
Beneficiary Account Specify the account number of the beneficiary.
Account Type Select the account type of the beneficiary from the drop-down list.
Account Name Specify the account name of the beneficiary.
Address Line 1 to Address Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Line 4
Remittance Information Specify the fields.
Remittance Information Specify the remittance information in free text format.
Line 1 to Remittance
Information Line 4
6-12
Chapter 6
Domestic Transfer Against Walk-in
2. On the Domestic Transfer Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down list. Specify the
transaction amount that needs to be transferred.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the payment details. For information on the fields in the Payment Details
segment, refer to Add Payment Details for Domestic Transfer.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
6-13
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for outgoing payment creation and processing with external
system status as Pending. After the transaction is processed and responded from
the Oracle Banking Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the
transaction from Journal Log and completes the transaction.
Note:
System shall automate the completion of payment transactions from
Journal log, once the ‘Success’ notification is received from Oracle
Banking Payments based on the flag Auto Processing as Y in
TRANSACTION.SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS. (When Auto Processing
is ‘N’, then Maker-Checker-Maker-Maker and when Auto Processing is Y
then Maker-Checker-Maker).
6-14
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
2. On the International Transfer Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Remitter Account Specify the customer account from which the funds need to be
debited.
Transfer Amount Specify the transfer account currency and the transfer amount that
needs to be debited from the customer account.
6-15
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
Field Description
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform the
Rate transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency. If this option is selected, the Negotiated
Reference Number field will become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction involves
cross currency.
Transaction Amount Displays the remitter account currency based on the account
number selected and the transaction amount based on the
exchange rate.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transfer account
currency into credit account currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transfer currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
6-16
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the payment details. For information on the fields in the Payment Details
segment, refer to Add Payment Details for International Transfer.
4. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking Payments
system for outgoing payment creation and processing with external system status as
Pending. After the transaction is processed and responded from Oracle Banking
Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal Log
and completes the transaction.
Note:
System shall automate the completion of payment transactions from Journal
log, once the ‘Success’ notification is received from Oracle Banking Payments
based on the flag Auto Processing as Y in
TRANSACTION.SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS. (When Auto Processing is ‘N’,
then Maker-Checker-Maker-Maker and when Auto Processing is Y then Maker-
Checker-Maker).
6-17
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
6-18
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Remitter Details Specify the fields.
Remitter Name Displays the remitter description based on the remitter account number
specified.
Address Line 1 to Address Displays the remitter address details.
Line 4
Communication Mode Specify the mode of communication for the transaction. The drop-down
values are E-Mail and Mobile No.
Mobile No Specify the mobile number.
Note:
This field is mandatory if the
Communication Mode is selected as
Mobile No.
Note:
This field is mandatory if the
Communication Mode is selected as E-
Mail.
Note:
The LOV display all valid swift BIC codes
maintained in the system.
6-19
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Account
Field Description
Beneficiary Bank Code Select the beneficiary bank code from the list of values.
Note:
The LOV display all valid clearing bank
codes maintained in the system.
Note:
If the beneficiary bank code is selected,
the system displays the description.
Receiver BIC Code Specify the receiver BIC code from the list of values.
Note:
The LOV displays all the valid swift BIC
codes maintained in the system.
6-20
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Walk-in
Field Description
Instruction Code 1 to Select the instruction codes from the drop-down list, and specify the
Instruction Code 6 additional information. The drop-down values are as follows:
• CHQB – Cheque, Pay beneficiary customer by cheque only.
• HOLD – Hold, Beneficiary customer/claimant will call; pay upon
identification.
• PHOB – Phone Beneficiary, Advise/contact beneficiary/claimant
by phone.
• PHOI – Phone Intermediary, Advise the intermediary institution by
phone.
• PHON – Telephone, Advise account with institution by phone.
• REPA – Related Payment, Payment has a related e-Payments
reference.
• TELB – Telecommunication, Advise/contact beneficiary/claimant
by the most efficient means of telecommunication.
• TELE – Telecommunication, Advise the account with the institution
by the most efficient means of telecommunication.
• TELI – Telecommunication, Advise the intermediary institution by
the most efficient means of telecommunication.
• INTC – Intra-Company Payment, A payment between two
companies belonging to the same group.
• SDVA – Same Day Value, Payment must be executed with same-
day value to the beneficiary.
• CORT – Corporate Trade, Payment is made in settlement of a
trade, for example, foreign exchange deal, securities transaction.
Note:
The field for additional information is
disabled for the following codes:
• CHQB
• INTC
• SDVA
• CORT
6-21
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Walk-in
2. On the International Transfer Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For
more information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Specify the currency in which the cash is accepted from the
walk-in customer and the transaction amount as requested by
the customer.
Transfer Currency Specify the currency in which the funds are to be transferred.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
6-22
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Walk-in
Field Description
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Transfer Amount Displays the transfer amount based on the exchange rate
pickup.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the transfer
currency into transaction currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transfer currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the payment details. For information on the fields in the Payment Details
segment, refer to Add Payment Details for International Transfer.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
6-23
Chapter 6
International Transfer Against Walk-in
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for outgoing payment creation and processing with external
system status as Pending. After the transaction is processed and responded from
Oracle Banking Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the
transaction from Journal Log and completes the transaction.
Note:
System shall automate the completion of payment transactions from
Journal log, once the ‘Success’ notification is received from Oracle
Banking Payments based on the flag Auto Processing as Y in
TRANSACTION.SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS. (When Auto Processing
is ‘N’, then Maker-Checker-Maker-Maker and when Auto Processing is Y
then Maker-Checker-Maker).
6-24
7
Clearing Transactions
The Teller can use screens under Clearing to perform the clearing transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Cheque Deposit
You can use the Cheque Deposit screen to capture the cheque deposit request
submitted by the customer.
• Cheque Return
The Teller can use the Cheque Return screen to initiate manual return of inward or
outward clearing cheques.
• Inward Clearing Data Entry
The Teller can use the Inward Clearing Data Entry screen to initiate the inward
processing of bulk instruments.
• Outward Clearing Data Entry
The Teller can use the Outward Clearing Data Entry screen to initiate the bulk deposit
of instruments.
7-1
Chapter 7
Cheque Deposit
2. On the Cheque Deposit screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Cheque Amount Specify the currency and amount mentioned in the cheque that
needs to be deposited in the account.
Cheque Date Specify the cheque issued date.
Deposit Mode Select the deposit mode as Account from the drop-down
values.
7-2
Chapter 7
Cheque Deposit
Field Description
Payee Account Specify the customer account number in which the cheque
needs to be deposited. When you press the Tab key, the
following details are displayed:
• Customer ID
• Image
• Signature
• KYC Status
• Account Balance
• Address
Note:
If the specified account number is a joint account
holder, the joint holder details of the account can be
viewed in the Customer Information Widget along
with the mode of operation.
Note:
You can also select from the list of maintained
clearing codes.
Routing Number Specify the routing number for cheque clearance. The list of
values will call the Oracle Banking Payments service to fetch
the list of routing numbers based on the Clearing Network
Code selected.
Cheque Deposit Date Displays the current posting date as the cheque deposit date.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
7-3
Chapter 7
Cheque Deposit
Field Description
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Note:
If the transfer currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charges (LCY) Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
7-4
Chapter 7
Cheque Deposit
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking Payments
system for Outward Clearing transaction processing with external system status as
Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from the Oracle Banking Payments
with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal Log and
completes the transaction.
OBBRN will only do data capture and populate the request to OBPM for main leg
accounting. Charge accounting will be posted to UBS from OBBRN.
Note:
System shall automate the completion of payment transactions from Journal
log, once the ‘Success’ notification is received from Oracle Banking Payments
based on the flag Auto Processing as Y in
TRANSACTION.SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS.
7-5
Chapter 7
Cheque Deposit
2. On the Cheque Deposit screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Cheque Amount Specify the currency and amount mentioned in the cheque that
needs to be deposited in the account.
Cheque Date Specify the cheque issued date.
Deposit Mode Select the deposit mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Payee GL Specify the customer GL number in which the cheque needs
to be deposited.
GL Description Displays the description of the specified Payee GL.
GL Currency Select the GL currency from the list of values.
Cheque Number Specify the MICR number displayed on the cheque.
7-6
Chapter 7
Cheque Deposit
Field Description
Drawer Account Specify the account number on which the cheque is drawn.
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer account.
Network Code Specify the network code.
Note:
You can also select from the list of maintained
clearing codes.
Routing Number Specify the routing number for cheque clearance. The list of
values will call the Oracle Banking Payments service to fetch
the list of routing numbers based on the Network Code
selected.
Cheque Deposit Date Displays the current posting date as the cheque deposit date.
Negotiated Exchange Specify the negotiated exchange rate if it is needed to perform
Rate the transaction using negotiated value.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency. If this option is selected,
the Negotiated Reference Number field will
become mandatory.
Negotiated Reference Specify the reference number for the negotiated cost rate.
Number
Note:
This field is applicable only if the transaction
involves cross currency.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the cheque
currency into transaction currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transfer currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
7-7
Chapter 7
Cheque Return
Field Description
Total Charges (LCY) Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for Outward Clearing transaction processing with external
system status as Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from the Oracle Banking
Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal
Log and completes the transaction.
7-8
Chapter 7
Cheque Return
2. On the Cheque Return screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Drawer Account Specify the drawer account number.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number.
Query Click Query to fetch cheque details.
Clear Click Clear to clear the cheque details.
Drawer Account Displays the drawer account number.
Drawer Routing No Displays the routing number of the specified drawer account.
Cheque Number Displays the cheque number.
Cheque Amount Displays the cheque amount.
Cheque Date Displays the cheque date.
7-9
Chapter 7
Inward Clearing Data Entry
Field Description
Payee Account Displays the payee account number.
Payee Name Displays the payee name.
Payee Routing No. Displays the payee routing number.
Return Type Displays the return type (Inward and Outward).
Reject Code Select the reject code from the list of values.
Reject Reason Displays the reason to reject.
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the system.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Cheque Return, and it can be
modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
Note:
Charges are not supported for this screen.
7-10
Chapter 7
Inward Clearing Data Entry
2. On the Inward Clearing Data Entry screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
New Click New to create a new clearing transaction and generate the
batch reference number.
Fetch Click Fetch to enable the field Batch Reference Number and input
or select from the list of values. The list of values fetches only the
batches that are saved and not submitted.
Hold Click Hold to save the data entry made as part of the specified
batch number.
Batch Reference Number Displays the unique batch number, which is system generated.
Instrument Currency Displays the current logged branch currency.
Note:
You can also select the instrument currency from the
drop-down values.
7-11
Chapter 7
Inward Clearing Data Entry
Field Description
Total Amount Displays the total batch amount in instrument currency.
Entry Details Specify the fields.
Instrument Type Select the instrument type from the drop-down values.
Drawer Account Specify the drawer account number.
Account Name Displays the name of the account number specified.
Account Branch Displays the branch code of the account number specified.
Account Currency Displays the currency of the account number specified.
Payee Account Specify the payee account number.
Note:
You can also select from the list of values.
Note:
You can also select from the list of values.
Note:
You can also select from the list of values.
Note:
You can also select from the list of values.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Inward Clearing Data Entry, and
it can be modified.
Add Entry Click Add Entry to add multiple records in the table and allow
modifying or deleting if required.
7-12
Chapter 7
Outward Clearing Data Entry
Field Description
Reset Click Reset to clear the inputted entry details before you add the
entries.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On submission of data entry, the individual instrument details will be handed off to Oracle
Banking Payments using Inward Clearing Service.
In case of reject notification of any transaction from Oracle Banking Payments, the teller
can either modify the data and resubmit the transaction or discard the data entry.
Note:
Charges are not supported for this screen.
7-13
Chapter 7
Outward Clearing Data Entry
2. On the Outward Clearing Data Entry screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
New Click New to create a new clearing transaction and generate
the batch reference number.
Fetch Click Fetch to enable the field Batch Reference Number and
input or select from the list of values. The list of values fetches
only the batches that are saved and not submitted.
Hold Click Hold to save the data entry made as part of the specified
batch number.
Batch Reference Displays the unique batch number, which is system generated.
Number
Instrument Currency Displays the current logged branch currency.
Note:
You can also select the instrument currency from
the drop-down values.
7-14
Chapter 7
Outward Clearing Data Entry
Field Description
Entry Details Specify the fields.
Payee Account Specify the payee account number.
Account Name Displays the name of the payee account number specified.
Account Currency Displays the currency of the payee account number specified.
Account Branch Displays the branch code of the payee account number
specified.
Instrument Type Select the instrument type from the drop-down values.
Drawer Account Specify the drawer account number.
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer account.
Instrument No Specify the instrument number.
Instrument Date Specify the date of the instrument.
Instrument Amount Specify the amount of the instrument.
Clearing Type Select the clearing type for the deposited instrument.
Drawer Routing No Specify the routing number of the cheque.
Note:
You can also select from the list of values.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On submission of data entry, the individual instrument details will be handed off to the
Oracle Banking Payments using Outward Clearing Service.
In case of reject acknowledgment of any transaction from the Oracle Banking Payments,
the teller can retry the individual record from the EJ screen until the batch is in Pending
status.
7-15
8
Remittances
The Teller can use Remittances to issue demand drafts and banker's cheques, perform
payment or cancellation of the issued remittances and perform further operations on the
issued remittances.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Banker's Cheque
The screens related to the Banker's Cheque (BC) can be used to issue BC, perform
payment or cancellation of the issued BC, and perform further operations on the issued
BC.
• Demand Drafts
The screens related to the Demand Drafts (DD) can be used to issue DD, perform
payment or cancellation of the issued DD, and perform further operations on the issued
DD.
• Cash Remittance
The screens related to the Cash Remittance can be used to issue remittance, perform
payment or cancellation of the issued remittance, and perform further operations on the
issued remittance.
• Travellers Cheque
This sub-section describes the various screens used to perform the remittances related
to Travellers Cheque. The screens are described in the following topics:
8-1
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
• Multi BC Issuance
The Teller can use the Multi BC Issuance screen to issue banker's cheques
against multiple beneficiaries.
2. On the BC Issue Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
8-2
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the code of the logged-in branch.
Branch Name Displays the description of issuing branch.
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code. The list of values contains the bank
codes maintained using the External Bank Code Maintenance
screen.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the logged-in
bank code as payable bank code. To remit funds across
banks, select the necessary bank code as payable bank
code. The Payable Branch Code and Payable Branch
Name fields will be enabled after you specify the Payable
Bank Code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branch codes maintained using the
Bank Code Maintenance screen.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
BC Amount Select the BC currency from the drop-down list and specify the BC
amount.
BC Date Select the date that needs to be mentioned in the BC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
MICR No Specify the MICR number and validate. If not specified, the system
generates the MICR number based on the maintenance setup.
BC No Displays the BC number.
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the drop-down values (Account or
Other Account).
8-3
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Charge Account Specify the charge account number. The following conditions apply
based on the value selected for Mode of Charge:
• If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the user needs
to capture the account from which the charges are to be
deducted.
Note:
If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the
system displays the Drawer Account by default. Else,
this field is kept blank and the user can input the
valid account number.
4. In the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
8-4
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Drawer Account Specify the account number of the customer who has requested the
BC.
Drawer Name Displays the name of the specified drawer account number.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number of the drawer account.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or Stopped
or Invalid cheque.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the following drop-down values
(Account or Other Account).
Charge Account This field is populated based on the following criteria:
• If Account is selected as Mode of Charge, the drawer account
number will be selected as charge account.
• If Other Account is selected as Mode of Charge, specify the
other account number in this field.
8-5
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charges applicable for the BC issuance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for instruments processing with external system status as
Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from the Oracle Banking
Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal
Log and completes the transaction.
Note:
System shall automate the completion of payment transactions from
Journal log, once the ‘Success’ notification is received from Oracle
Banking Payments based on the flag Auto Processing as Y in
TRANSACTION.SRV_TM_BC_PARAM_DTLS. (When Auto Processing
is ‘N’, then Maker-Checker-Maker-Maker and when Auto Processing is Y
then Maker-Checker-Maker).
8-6
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click BC Issue - Walk-
in or specify BC Issue - Walk-in in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The BC Issue Against Walk-in screen is displayed.
2. On the BC Issue Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the code of the logged-in branch.
Branch Name Displays the description of issuing branch.
8-7
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code. The list of values contains the bank
codes maintained using the External Bank Code Maintenance
screen.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the logged-in
bank code as payable bank code. To remit funds across
banks, select the necessary bank code as payable bank
code. The fields Payable Branch Code and Payable
Branch Name will be enabled after you specify the
Payable Bank Code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branch codes maintained using the
Bank Code Maintenance screen.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
BC Amount Select the BC currency from the drop-down list and specify the BC
amount.
BC Date Select the date that needs to be mentioned in the BC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
8-8
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
4. In the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency in which the walk-in customer
deposits the cash.
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the payee.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the payee from the drop-down list.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the payee.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-9
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charges applicable for the BC issuance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
7. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for instruments processing with external system status as
Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from the Oracle Banking
Payments with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal
Log and completes the transaction.
8-10
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Issue Against GL screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
Branch Name Displays the description of issuing branch.
8-11
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code. The list of values contains the bank
codes maintained using the External Bank Code Maintenance
screen.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the logged-in
bank code as payable bank code. To remit funds across
banks, select the necessary bank code as payable bank
code. The fields Payable Branch Code and Payable
Branch Name will be enabled after you specify the
Payable Bank Code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branch codes maintained using the
Bank Code Maintenance screen.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
BC Amount Select the BC currency from the drop-down list and the BC amount.
BC Date Select the date that needs to be mentioned in the BC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Note:
If not specified, the system generates the BC number
based on the maintenance setup.
8-12
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
4. In the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
GL Account Select the account number of the GL against which the BC is issued
from the LOV.
GL Description Displays a brief description of the general ledger.
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the payee from the drop-down list.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the payee.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking Payments
system for instruments processing with external system status as Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from the Oracle Banking Payments
with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal Log and
completes the transaction.
8-13
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Print-Reprint screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Bankers Cheque No Specify the BC number of the instrument that you need to print
or re-print.
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Print Type Select the type Print or Reprint from the drop-down list.
8-14
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Query Click Query to fetch details of the BC transaction.
Issuing Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
BC Date Displays the date mentioned in the BC.
BC Amount Displays the BC currency and the BC amount.
Drawer Name Displays the name of the drawer.
BC Status Displays the status of the BC.
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Details Displays the identification details of the beneficiary.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Reprint Count Specify the count of the current reprint operation.
Note:
This is applicable only for the reprint option.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
8.1.5 BC Operations
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to handle the life cycle processing of Banker's
Cheque (BC) that is already issued.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• BC Inquiry
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to inquire about the details of BC.
• BC Revalidation
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to revalidate an instrument that is in
expired status.
8-15
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
• BC Duplicate Issue
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to issue the instrument if the
customer or banker lost the instrument or if the instrument is damaged.
• BC Payment Reversal
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to make the reversal of payment for
BC. Reversal of BC Payment is not supported through Electronic Journal/Service
Journal.
• BC Payment by Account
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to make payment against a BC.
• BC Payment by Cash
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to make payment against a BC.
• BC Payment by GL
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to make payment against a BC.
• BC Refund by Account
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to refund the amount against a BC.
• BC Refund by Cash
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to refund the amount against a BC.
• BC Refund by GL
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to refund the amount against a BC.
• Cancel BC by Account
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to cancel a BC.
• Cancel BC by Cash
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to cancel a BC.
• Cancel BC by GL
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to cancel a BC.
8.1.5.1 BC Inquiry
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to inquire about the details of BC.
To inquire the details of BC:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click BC
Operations or specify BC Operations in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The BC Operations screen is displayed.
8-16
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Inquiry from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV. After you specify the Issue Branch Code and Bankers
Cheque No, press the Tab key. The system will make a service call
to the Oracle Banking Payments and fetch the banker's cheque
details.
BC Currency Specify BC Currency to query instrument details.
Query Click this icon to fetch instrument details.
BC Details Displays the details of BC under this segment.
Issue Branch Displays the logged-in branch code.
Payable Bank Code Displays the payable bank code.
Payable Branch Displays the payable branch for the BC.
BC Amount Displays the BC currency and the BC amount.
MICR No Displays the MICR number.
Issue Date Displays the issue date mentioned in the BC.
Issue Mode Displays the issue mode of the BC.
Bankers Cheque Status Displays the status of the BC.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as BC Inquiry, and it can be modified.
8-17
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Revalidation Date Displays the date of BC revalidation.
Duplicate Issue Date Displays the duplicate issue date of BC.
Liquidation Date Displays the liquidation date of BC.
Liquidation Mode Displays the liquidation mode of BC.
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Customer ID Displays the Customer ID.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
8-18
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
8.1.5.2 BC Revalidation
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to revalidate an instrument that is in expired
status.
When a customer requests for revalidation of an instrument that is in expired status, Teller
can validate the instrument details and initiate revalidation of BC. The system will allow for
revalidation only if:
• Revalidation is allowed at the Instrument type level
• The instrument is not liquidated, canceled, or refunded
• The instrument is issued, revalidated, or duplicate issued but not liquidated/refunded/
canceled
• Rule based authorization is not supported for revalidation
To revalidate an instrument:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click BC Operations or
specify BC Operations in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The BC Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-19
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Revalidate from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Revalidation Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Revalidation Date Select the revalidation date.
Note:
By default, the system date is displayed as the
revalidation date.
New Expiry Date Displays the new expiry date based on the specified
revalidation date.
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the drop-down values
(Account or Cash).
Charge Account Specify the charge account number. The following conditions
apply based on the value selected for Mode of Charge:
• If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the user
needs to capture the account from which the charges are
to be deducted.
Note:
If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account,
the system displays the Drawer Account by
default. Else, this field is kept blank and the
user can input the valid account number.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the
BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
8-20
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-21
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Duplicate Issue from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Duplicate Issue Details Specify the details under this segment.
Duplicate Issue Date By default, the current system date is displayed as a duplicate
issue date, and it can be modified.
Duplicate BC No Specify the duplicate banker's cheque number.
Duplicate MICR No Specify the duplicate MICR number.
Requested By Select from the drop-down values (Customer or Bank).
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the drop-down values
(Account or Cash).
8-22
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Charge Account Specify the charge account number. The following conditions
apply based on the value selected for Mode of Charge:
• If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the user
needs to capture the account from which the charges are
to be deducted.
Note:
If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account,
the system displays the Drawer Account by
default. Else, this field is kept blank and the
user can input the valid account number.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
8-23
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment Reversal from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Reversal Details Specify the details under this segment.
Liquidation Mode Select the liquidation mode from the drop-down values.
Liquidation Date Select the liquidation date.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as BC Payment Reversal, and it
can be modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the
BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
8-24
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
8-25
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down
values.
Payment Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
8-26
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-27
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down
values.
Payment Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
8-28
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
8-29
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting
is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the Oracle
Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8.1.5.7 BC Payment by GL
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to make payment against a BC.
The BC payment is credited to the GL account when the operation mode is GL.
To make payment against a BC:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click BC
Operations or specify BC Operations in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The BC Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
8-30
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Payment Details Specify the details under this segment.
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Currency Displays the currency of the specified GL account.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the specified GL account.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
8-31
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from the Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the
transaction.
8-32
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
8-33
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the
BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
8-34
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction
accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the
Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
8-35
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the
BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
8-36
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8.1.5.10 BC Refund by GL
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to refund the amount against a BC.
The BC payment is credited to the GL account when the operation mode is GL.
To refund the amount:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click BC Operations or
specify BC Operations in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The BC Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
8-37
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Currency Displays the currency of the specified GL account.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the specified GL account.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-38
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from the Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-39
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down
values.
Cancel Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
8-40
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-41
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from the Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the
transaction.
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
8-42
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down values.
Cancel Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
8-43
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from the Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the
transaction.
8.1.5.13 Cancel BC by GL
The Teller can use the BC Operations screen to cancel a BC.
The BC cancellation amount is credited to the GL account when the operation mode is
GL.
To cancel a BC:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click BC
Operations or specify BC Operations in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The BC Operations screen is displayed.
8-44
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the BC Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
BC No Specify the BC number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Cancel Details Specify the details under this segment.
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Currency Displays the currency of the specified GL account.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the specified GL account.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-45
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View BC Details data segment to view the additional details of the
BC.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from the Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the
transaction.
8-46
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
8-47
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the Multi BC Issuance Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
New Click New to generate a batch reference number.
Batch Reference Displays the auto-generated batch reference number.
BC Currency Select the BC currency from the LOV.
Issue Mode Select the issue mode as Account from the drop-down values.
Drawer Account Specify the remitter account number. When you press the Tab
key, the Account Description, Remitter Name, and Address
of the remitter account will be populated.
Drawer Name Displays the name of the specified remitter account number.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the specified remitter account number.
Address Line 4
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
8-48
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Note:
By default, the drawer account number will be
displayed as a charge account, and it can be
modified.
Total (Account Amount) Displays the total amount available in the specified charge
account.
Entry Details Specify the fields.
Payee Name Specify the name of the payee.
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code from the list of values.
Payable Bank Name Displays the bank name of the specified payable bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the payable branch code from the list of values.
Payable Branch Name Displays the bank name of the specified payable branch code.
BC Amount Specify the BC amount.
MICR Number Specify the MICR number.
BC Number Specify the BC number.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the payee.
Address Line 4
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Multi BC Issuance, and it
can be modified.
Add Entry After filling the necessary fields, click Add Entry to add a new
entry.
Reset Click Reset to reset the added entries.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-49
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
8-50
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
2. On the Multi BC Issuance Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
New Click New to generate a batch reference number.
Batch Reference Displays the auto-generated batch reference number.
BC Currency Select the BC currency from the list of values.
Issue Mode Select the issue mode as Cash from the drop-down values.
Transaction Currency Select the transaction currency from the list of values.
8-51
Chapter 8
Banker's Cheque
Field Description
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the drawer.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type from the drop-down values.
Payee Identification Specify the identification number of the Payee.
Number
Total BC Amount Displays the total sum of the multiple BC amount inputs, which is
computed by the system.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Total (Account Amount) Displays the total amount available in the specified charge account.
Entry Details Specify the fields.
Payee Name Specify the payee name.
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code from the list of values.
Payable Bank Name Displays the bank name of the specified payable bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the payable branch code from the list of values.
Payable Branch Name Displays the bank name of the specified payable branch code.
BC Amount Specify the BC amount and currency.
MICR Number Specify the MICR number.
BC Number Specify the BC number.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the payee.
Address Line 4
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Multi BC Issuance, and it can be
modified.
Add Entry After filling the necessary fields, click Add Entry to add a new entry.
8-52
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Reset Click Reset to reset the added entries.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
8-53
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Issue Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
8-54
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Branch Name Displays the branch description of issuing branch.
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code. The list of values contains the
bank codes maintained using the External Bank Code
Maintenance screen.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the
logged-in bank code as payable bank code. To remit
funds across banks, select the necessary bank
code as payable bank code. The fields Payable
Branch Code and Payable Branch Name will be
enabled after you specify the Payable Bank Code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branch codes maintained using the
Bank Code Maintenance screen.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
DD Amount Specify the DD currency and DD amount.
DD Date Specify the date that needs to be mentioned in the DD.
MICR No Displays the MICR number.
DD No Specify the instrument number and validate. If not specified,
the system generates the DD number based on the
maintenance setup.
Payee Details Specify the fields.
Payee Name Specify the payee name on which the DD is drawn.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the payee.
Address Line 4
Narrative Displays the narrative as DD Issuance Account and it can be
modified.
8-55
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
4. On the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Drawer Account Specify the account number of the customer who has
requested the DD.
Drawer Name Displays the name of the specified drawer account number.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number of the drawer account.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
8-56
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the following drop-down
values (Account or Other Account).
Charge Account This field is populated based on the following criteria:
• If Account is selected as Mode of Charge, the drawer
account number will be selected as charge account.
• If Other Account is selected as Mode of Charge, specify
the other account number in this field.
Total Charges Displays the total charges applicable for the DD issuance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-57
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for instruments processing with external system status as
Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from Oracle Banking Payments
with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal Log and
completes the transaction.
8-58
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Issue Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
Branch Name Displays the branch description of issuing branch.
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code. The list of values contains the bank
codes maintained using the External Bank Code Maintenance
screen.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the logged-in
bank code as payable bank code. To remit funds across
banks, select the necessary bank code as payable bank
code. The fields Payable Branch Code and Payable
Branch Name will be enabled after you specify the
Payable Bank Code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branch codes maintained using the
Bank Code Maintenance screen.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
DD Amount Specify the DD currency and DD amount.
DD Date Specify the date that needs to be mentioned in the DD.
MICR No Displays the serial number.
DD No Specify the instrument number and validate.
Note:
If not specified, the system generates the DD number
based on the maintenance setup.
8-59
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Narrative Displays the narrative as DD Issuance against Walk-in, and it can
be modified.
4. On the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency, the currency in which the
walk-in customer deposit the cash.
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the payee.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the payee from the drop-down
list.
Identification Number Specify the identification details of the payee.
8-60
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charges applicable for the DD issuance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
5. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
6. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
7. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking Payments
system for instruments processing with external system status as Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from Oracle Banking Payments with
appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal Log and completes the
transaction.
8-61
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click DD Issue -
GL or specify DD Issue - GL in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The DD Issue Against GL screen is displayed.
2. On the DD Issue Against GL screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
Branch Name Displays the branch description of issuing branch.
8-62
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code. The list of values contains the
bank codes maintained using the External Bank Code
Maintenance screen.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the
logged-in bank code as payable bank code. To remit
funds across banks, select the necessary bank
code as payable bank code. The fields Payable
Branch Code and Payable Branch Name will be
enabled after you specify the Payable Bank Code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branch codes maintained using the
Bank Code Maintenance screen.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
DD Amount Specify the DD currency and DD amount.
DD Date Specify the date that needs to be mentioned in the DD.
MICR No Displays the serial number.
DD No Specify the instrument number and validate.
Note:
If not specified, the system generates the DD
number based on the maintenance setup.
8-63
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
4. On the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
GL Account Select the account number of the GL against which the BC is
issued from the LOV.
GL Description Displays a brief description of the general ledger.
Drawer Name Specify the name of the drawer.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the payee from the drop-down
list.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the payee.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
When you submit, the transaction details are handed off to the Oracle Banking
Payments system for instruments processing with external system status as
Pending.
After the transaction is processed and responded from Oracle Banking Payments
with appropriate status, the Teller selects the transaction from Journal Log and
completes the transaction.
8-64
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Print-Reprint screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument that you need to print or
reprint.
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
8-65
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Print Type Select the type Print or Reprint from the drop-down list.
Query Click Query to fetch details of DD print or reprint.
Issuing Branch Code Displays the logged-in branch code.
DD Date Displays the date mentioned in the DD.
DD Amount Displays the DD currency and the DD amount.
Drawer Name Displays the name of the drawer.
DD Status Displays the status of the DD.
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Details Displays the identification details of the beneficiary.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Reprint Count Specify the count of the current reprint operation.
Note:
This field is applicable only for the reprint option.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
8.2.5 DD Operations
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to handle the life cycle processing of
DD that is already issued.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• DD Inquiry
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to inquire about the details of DD.
• DD Revalidation
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to revalidate an instrument that is in
expired status.
8-66
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
• DD Duplicate Issue
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to issue the instrument if the customer or
banker lost the instrument or if the instrument is damaged.
• DD Payment Reversal
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to make the reversal of payment for DD.
Reversal of DD Payment through EJ/SJ is not supported through Electronic Journal/
Service Journal.
• DD Payment by Account
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to make payment against a DD.
• DD Payment by Cash
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to make payment against a DD.
• DD Payment by GL
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to make payment against a DD.
• DD Refund by Account
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to refund the amount against a DD.
• DD Refund by Cash
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to refund the amount against a DD.
• DD Refund by GL
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to refund the amount against a DD.
• Cancel DD by Account
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to cancel a DD.
• Cancel DD by Cash
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to cancel a DD.
• Cancel DD by GL
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to cancel a DD.
8.2.5.1 DD Inquiry
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to inquire about the details of DD.
To inquire the details of DD:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click DD Operations or
specify DD Operations in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The DD Operations screen is displayed.
8-67
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Inquiry from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV. After you specify the Issue Branch Code and
Demand Draft No, press the Tab key. The system will make a
service call to Oracle Banking Payments and fetch the demand
draft details.
BC Currency Specify BC Currency to query instrument details.
Query Click this icon to fetch instrument details.
Demand Draft Details Displays the details of DD under this segment.
Issue Branch Displays the logged-in branch code.
Payable Bank Code Displays the payable bank code.
Payable Branch Displays the payable branch for the DD.
Demand Draft Amount Displays the DD currency and the DD amount.
MICR No Displays the MICR number.
Issue Date Displays the issue date mentioned in the DD.
Issue Mode Displays the issue mode of the DD.
Demand Draft Status Displays the status of the DD.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Demand Draft Inquiry, and it
can be modified.
8-68
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Revalidation Date Displays the date of DD revalidation.
Duplicate Issue Date Displays the duplicate issue date of DD.
Liquidation Date Displays the liquidation date of DD.
Liquidation Mode Displays the liquidation mode of DD.
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Customer ID Displays the Customer ID.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1.
8-69
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
8.2.5.2 DD Revalidation
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to revalidate an instrument that is in
expired status.
When a customer requests for revalidation of an instrument that is in expired status,
Teller can validate the instrument details and initiate revalidation of DD. The system
will allow for revalidation only if:
• Revalidation is allowed at the Instrument type level
• The instrument is not liquidated, canceled, or refunded
• The instrument is issued, revalidated, or duplicate issued but not liquidated/
refunded/canceled
• Rule based authorization is not supported for revalidation
To revalidate a DD:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click DD
Operations or specify DD Operations in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The DD Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-70
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Revalidate from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Revalidation Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Revalidation Date Select the revalidation date.
Note:
By default, the system date is displayed as a revalidation
date.
New Expiry Date Displays the new expiry date based on the specified revalidation
date.
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the drop-down values (Account or
Cash).
Charge Account Specify the charge account number. The following conditions apply
based on the value selected for Mode of Charge:
• If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the user needs
to capture the account from which the charges are to be
deducted.
Note:
If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the
system displays the Drawer Account by default. Else,
this field is kept blank and the user can input the
valid account number.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View Demand Draft Details data segment to view the additional details of
the DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
8-71
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-72
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Duplicate Issue from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Duplicate Issue Details Specify the details under this segment.
Duplicate Issue Date By default, the current system date is displayed as a duplicate issue
date, and it can be modified.
Duplicate Demand Draft Specify the duplicate demand draft number.
No
Duplicate MICR No Specify the duplicate MICR number.
Requested By Select from the drop-down values (Customer or Bank).
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the drop-down values (Account or
Cash).
8-73
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Charge Account Specify the charge account number. The following conditions apply
based on the value selected for Mode of Charge:
• If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the user needs
to capture the account from which the charges are to be
deducted.
Note:
If the Mode of Charge is selected as Account, the
system displays the Drawer Account by default. Else,
this field is kept blank, and the user can input the
valid account number.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View Demand Draft Details data segment to view the additional
details of the DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
8-74
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment Reversal from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Reversal Details Specify the details under this segment.
Liquidation Mode Select the liquidation mode from the drop-down values.
Liquidation Date Select the liquidation date.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Demand Draft Payment Reversal,
and it can be modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the DD.
8-75
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-76
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down values.
Payment Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Specify the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
8-77
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the
DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-78
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-79
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down
values.
Payment Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the
DD.
8-80
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8.2.5.7 DD Payment by GL
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to make payment against a DD.
The DD payment is credited to the GL account when the operation mode is GL.
To make payment against a DD:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click DD Operations or
specify DD Operations in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The DD Operations screen is displayed.
8-81
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Payment Details Specify the details under this segment.
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Currency Displays the currency of the specified GL account.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the specified GL account.
8-82
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-83
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-84
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
8-85
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
4. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the
DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-86
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
8-87
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the
DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
8-88
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction
accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from Oracle
Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8.2.5.10 DD Refund by GL
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to refund the amount against a DD.
The DD payment is credited to the GL account when the operation mode is GL.
To refund the amount:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click DD Operations or
specify DD Operations in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The DD Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer to
the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
8-89
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Currency Specify the currency of the specified GL account.
GL Branch Select the branch code from the list of values.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Demand Draft Refund by GL, and
it can be modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the
DD.
8-90
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments product
processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a success
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the transaction status
as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The transaction accounting is not
applicable for the transaction. In case of reject notification from Oracle Banking
Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-91
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down
values.
Cancel Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
8-92
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-93
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-94
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down values.
Cancel Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary's name.
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
8-95
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8.2.5.13 Cancel DD by GL
The Teller can use the DD Operations screen to cancel a DD.
The DD cancellation amount is credited to the GL account when the operation mode is
GL.
To cancel a DD:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click DD
Operations or specify DD Operations in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The DD Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the DD Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
8-96
Chapter 8
Demand Drafts
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
Demand Draft No Specify the DD number of the instrument.
Issue Branch Select the branch code where the instrument is issued from the
LOV.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Refund Details Specify the details under this segment.
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Currency Displays the currency of the specified GL account.
GL Branch Displays the branch code of the specified GL account.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-97
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Narrative Displays the default narrative as DD Cancel by GL, and it can be
modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the View DD Details data segment to view the additional details of the
DD.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the details to the payments
product processor (Oracle Banking Payments) for processing. When you get a
success notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will update the
transaction status as Success and mark for charges accounting handoff. The
transaction accounting is not applicable for the transaction. In case of reject
notification from Oracle Banking Payments, the system will discard the transaction.
8-98
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
8-99
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Issue Against Account screen, specify the fields. For
more information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Displays the code of the home branch.
Issuing Branch Name Displays the name of the issuing branch code.
Payable Bank Code Select the payable bank code from the list of values.
Note:
To remit funds within the same bank, select the
logged-in bank code as payable bank code. To remit
funds across banks, select the necessary bank
code as payable bank code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the name of the selected bank code.
8-100
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Payable Branch Code Select the branch code of the payable bank. The list of values
contains the corresponding branches maintained for the
payable bank code.
Payable Branch Name Displays the branch name of the selected branch code.
Remittance Amount Specify the cash remittance currency and amount, which
needs to be transferred.
Remittance Date Select the date of cash remittance.
Remittance No Specify the cash remittance number.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Issue Mode Select the issue mode from the drop-down values (Account,
Cash, or GL).
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Beneficiary Name Specify the name of the beneficiary.
Beneficiary Account Specify the account number of the beneficiary.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type.
Identification No Specify the identification number.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Cash Remittance Issuance,
and it can be modified.
4. In the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
8-101
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Remitter Account Specify the remitter account number.
Remitter Name Displays the name of the specified remitter account.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the specified remitter account.
Address Line 4
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-102
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
8-103
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Issue Against Cash screen, specify the fields. For
more information on fields, refer to Table 8-43.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-104
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
4. In the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Transaction Amount Displays the transaction currency and amount.
Note:
By default, the currency field will default to local branch
currency and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
8-105
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
7. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
8-106
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Issue Against GL screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to Table 8-43.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-107
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
4. In the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
GL Account Specify the GL account number.
GL Description Displays the description of the specified GL account number.
GL Currency Select the GL currency from the list of values.
Remitter Name Specify the name of the remitter.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the remitter.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type.
Identification Number Specify the identification number.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-108
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Mode of Charge Select the mode of charge from the drop-down values.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
8-109
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
8-110
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the cash remittance is issued from
the LOV.
Operation Mode Select the type Inquiry from the drop-down list.
Remittance No Specify the cash remittance number.
8-111
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Query Click this icon to fetch the cash remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Cash Remittance No, the system will
make a service call to the Oracle Banking Payments and
fetch the cash remittance details.
Remittance Details Displays the details of cash remittance under this segment.
Issue Branch Displays the logged-in branch code.
Payable Bank Code Displays the payable bank code for the cash remittance.
Payable Branch Code Displays the payable branch code for the cash remittance.
Remittance Amount Displays the currency and the amount of the cash remittance.
Issue Date Displays the issue date mentioned in the cash remittance.
Remittance Status Displays the status of the cash remittance.
Remittance No Displays the cash remittance number.
Test Key No Displays the test key number.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Cash Remittance Inquiry, and it
can be modified.
Issue Mode Displays the issue mode of the Cash Remittance.
Liquidation Date Displays the liquidation date of Cash Remittance.
Liquidation Mode Displays the liquidation mode of Cash Remittance.
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Displays the identification type of the beneficiary.
Identification Number Displays the identification number of the beneficiary.
Funding Details Funding details are displayed under this segment.
Remitter Account Displays the account number of the remitter.
Remitter Name Displays the remitter name.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Cheque Number Displays the cheque number.
Cheque Date Displays the date mentioned in the cheque.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
8-112
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Account Amount Displays the amount that needs to be debited from the remitter
account.
Identification Type Displays the identification type of the remitter.
Identification Number Displays the identification number of the remitter.
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-113
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued from
the LOV.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down
values.
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will
make a service call to Oracle Banking Payments
and fetch the remittance details.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
8-114
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Account Amount Displays the account amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another bank, the
Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during handoff for validation.
On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will hand off accounting to
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-115
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
8-116
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Remittance No Specify the remittance number.
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down
values.
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will
make a service call to Oracle Banking Payments
and fetch the remittance details.
Note:
By default, the local branch currency is displayed as
transaction currency and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at the Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
8-117
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Total Charges Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another
bank, the Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during
handoff for validation. On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will
hand off accounting to FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-118
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number of the instrument.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Operation Type Select the type Payment from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
8-119
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will make
a service call to Oracle Banking Payments and fetch the
remittance details.
Note:
You can also select a currency from the list of values.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
8-120
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
GL Amount Displays the GL amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another bank, the
Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during handoff for validation.
On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will hand off accounting to
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-121
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
8-122
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down
values.
Query Click this icon to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will
make a service call to the Oracle Banking Payments
and fetch the remittance details.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
8-123
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another
bank, the Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during
handoff for validation. On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will
hand off accounting to FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-124
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Remittances, click Cash Remittance
Operations or specify Cash Remittance Operations in the search icon bar and select
the screen.
The Cash Remittance Operations screen is displayed.
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down values.
8-125
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Query Click this icon to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will make
a service call to Oracle Banking Payments and fetch the
remittance details.
Note:
By default, the local branch currency is displayed as a
transaction currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
8-126
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Cash Remittance Operation by
Refund, and it can be modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another bank, the
Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during handoff for validation.
On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will hand off accounting to
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-127
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Operation Type Select the type Refund from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will
make a service call to Oracle Banking Payments
and fetch the remittance details.
8-128
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
GL Description Displays the description of the specified GL account number.
GL Currency Specify the currency of the specified GL account.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification No Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
8-129
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another
bank, the Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during
handoff for validation. On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will
hand off accounting to FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-130
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number of the instrument.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Account from the drop-down values.
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will make
a service call to Oracle Banking Payments and fetch the
remittance details.
8-131
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification No Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
8-132
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another bank, the
Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during handoff for validation.
On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will hand off accounting to
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-133
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Branch Code Select the branch code where the remittance is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as Cash from the drop-down
values.
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will
make a service call to Oracle Banking Payments
and fetch the remittance details.
8-134
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Beneficiary Details Specify the details under this segment.
Transaction Amount Displays the transaction currency and transaction amount.
Note:
By default, the local branch currency is displayed as
a transaction currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is displayed only if
Multi-Currency Configuration at Function
Code Indicator level is set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
8-135
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another
bank, the Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during
handoff for validation. On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will
hand off accounting to FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-136
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Cash Remittance Operations screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issue Branch Code Select the branch code where the instrument is issued.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number of the instrument.
Operation Type Select the type Cancel from the drop-down list.
Operation Mode Select the operation mode as GL from the drop-down values.
Query Click Query to fetch the remittance details.
Note:
When you click this icon, after you specify the Issue
Branch Code and Remittance No, the system will make
a service call to Oracle Banking Payments and fetch the
remittance details.
8-137
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Table 8-56 (Cont.) Cash Remittance Operations (Cancel by GL) - Field Description
Field Description
GL Description Displays the description of the specified GL account number.
GL Currency Specify the currency of the specified GL account.
Beneficiary Name Specify the beneficiary name.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-down
values.
Identification No Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system will display the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click on the Remittance Details data segment to view the additional details of the
remittance.
8-138
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Note:
This data segment is non-editable.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the system will hand off the request to Oracle Banking
Payments using Instrument Pay Service. If the remittance is issued by another bank, the
Oracle Banking Branch has to provide the test key number during handoff for validation.
On transaction completion, the Oracle Banking Branch will hand off accounting to
FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the main leg.
8-139
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
2. On the Inward Remittance Registration screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Inward Remittance Specify the inward remittance reference issued by the external
Reference bank during registration of the remittance.
Remittance Amount Specify the remittance currency and amount.
Note:
By default, the logged-in branch local currency is
displayed as remittance currency, and it can be
modified.
8-140
Chapter 8
Cash Remittance
Field Description
Issuing Bank Code Specify the code of the external issuing bank.
Issuing Bank Name Displays the name of the specified external issuing bank.
Issue Branch Code Specify the branch code of the external issuing bank.
Issue Branch Name Displays the name of the specified external issuing branch.
Payable Bank Code Specify the payable bank code.
Payable Bank Name Displays the payable bank name.
Payable Branch Code Specify the payable branch code.
Payable Branch Name Displays the payable branch name.
Remittance Date Select the issue date of the TT.
Remittance No Specify the remittance number of the TT.
Test Key No Specify the test key number.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Inward Remittance
Registration, and it can be modified.
Beneficiary Details Specify the details under this segment.
Beneficiary Account Displays the beneficiary account number.
Beneficiary Name Displays the beneficiary's name.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification No Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Beneficiary Phone No Specify the phone number of the beneficiary.
Funding Details Specify the fields.
Remitter Account Specify the account number of the remitter.
Remitter Name Displays the name of the specified remitter account.
Address Line 1 to Displays the address of the specified remitter account.
Address Line 4
Identification Type Select the identification type of the beneficiary from the drop-
down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number of the beneficiary.
Identification Type Select the identification type.
Identification Number Specify the identification number.
Remitter Phone No Specify the phone number of the remitter.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
8-141
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves.
8-142
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
2. On the TC Sale by Other Modes screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Bank Code Displays the code of the issuing bank.
Issuing Bank Name Displays the name of the issuing bank.
Issuing Branch Code Displays the code of the issuing branch.
Branch Name Displays the name of the issuing branch.
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the HO code of the logged-in
branch and the issuer codes maintained in the Issuer
Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified Issuer Code.
Issue Mode Select the mode of issue from the drop-down values (By Account
or By GL).
TC Amount Select the TC currency from the drop-down values, and specify the
TC Amount.
8-143
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
TC Date Select the date of the TC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Account Number Specify the account number of the customer. When you press the
Tab key, the system defaults the Account Name.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Issue Mode is selected
as By Account.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Issue Mode is selected
as By Account.
Account Amount Displays the account amount based on the Exchange Rate, TC
Amount, and Account Number selected.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Issue Mode is selected
as By Account.
GL Number Click the search icon, and select the GL number from the list of
values.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Issue Mode is selected
as By GL.
8-144
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
GL Description Displays the description of the specified GL account.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Issue Mode is selected
as By GL.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Issue Mode is selected
as By GL.
Note:
If the TC currency is the same as the account currency,
the system displays the exchange rate as 1. This field is
displayed only if Multi-Currency Configuration at
the Function Code indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
8-145
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission,
the TC position (TC outflow) is updated to the teller position for the
combination of Issuer Code, TC Currency, TC Denom code, and Series
to the extent of TC denomination units being purchased.
8-146
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Denom Code Specify the TC denomination code from the list of values.
Currency Displays the default TC Currency.
Series Specify the series of the TC Denom Code that needs to be sold from
Teller’s Till.
Note:
The list of values contains the valid TC
series that are available with the Teller
TC position. On click of LOV, the search
criterion field will have Series, and the
result criterion will display the Series and
Start Number.
Note:
Based on the series selected, the system
will populate the Start Number available
for the combination of Currency, TC
Denom Code, and Series.
End Number Displays the end number, which is the sum of the start number and the
count.
TC Amount Displays the TC Amount, which is the product of the denomination and
the count.
Total TC Amount Displays the total TC amount along with the currency.
Denomination Amount Displays the denomination amount along with the currency.
8-147
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
2. On the TC Sale Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Bank Code Displays the code of the issuing bank.
Issuing Bank Name Displays the name of the issuing bank.
Issuing Branch Code Displays the code of the issuing branch.
Issuing Branch Name Displays the name of the issuing branch.
8-148
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Issuer Code Click the search icon, and select the issuer code from the list
of values.
Note:
The list of values provides the HO code of the
logged-in branch and the issuer codes maintained
in the Issuer Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified Issuer Code.
TC Amount Select the TC currency from the drop-down values, and
specify the TC Amount.
TC Date Select the date of the TC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Transaction Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values.
When you press the Tab key, the system displays the
transaction amount based on the Exchange Rate, TC
Amount, and Account Number selected.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the TC currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
8-149
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Beneficiary Name Specify the name of the beneficiary.
Identification Type Select the identification type from the drop-down values.
Identification Number Specify the identification number.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction submission,
the TC position (TC outflow) is updated to the teller position for the
combination of Issuer Code, TC Currency, TC denom Code, and Series
to the extent of TC denomination units being purchased.
8-150
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
2. On the TC Purchase Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuing Bank Code Specify the code of the issuing bank.
Note:
By default, the logged-in bank code is displayed.
Issuing Bank Name Displays the name of the issuing bank specified.
Issuing Branch Code Specify the code of the issuing branch.
Note:
By default, the logged-in branch code is displayed.
8-151
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the HO code of the logged-in
branch and the issuer codes maintained in the Issuer
Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified Issuer Code.
TC Amount Select the TC currency from the drop-down values, and specify the
TC Amount.
Purchase Date Select the purchase date of the TC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Account Number Specify the account number of the Customer. When you press the
Tab key, the system defaults the Account Name.
Account Name Displays the name of the account.
Account Amount Displays the account amount based on the Exchange Rate, TC
Amount, and Account Number selected.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the TC currency is the same as the account currency,
the system displays the exchange rate as 1. This field is
displayed only if Multi-Currency Configuration at
the Function Code indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
8-152
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Beneficiary Details Specify the fields under this section.
Beneficiary Name Specify the name of the beneficiary.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary.
Address Line 4
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves.
8-153
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Denom Code Specify the TC denomination code from the list of values.
Currency Displays the default TC Currency.
Series Specify the series of the TC Denom Code that is being purchased
from the Agent.
Note:
You can also select from the list of
values if the bank is purchasing the
TC which is already sold.
Note:
You can also select from the list of
values if the bank is purchasing the
TC which is already sold.
End Number Displays the end number, which is the sum of the start number
and the count.
TC Amount Displays the TC Amount, which is the product of the
denomination and the count.
Total TC Amount Displays the total TC amount along with the currency.
Denomination Amount Displays the denomination amount along with the currency.
8-154
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
2. On the TC Purchase Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
8-155
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Issuing Bank Code Specify the code of the issuing bank.
Note:
By default, the logged-in bank code is displayed.
Issuing Bank Name Displays the name of the issuing bank specified.
Issuing Branch Code Specify the code of the issuing branch.
Note:
By default, the logged-in branch code is displayed.
Issuing Branch Name Displays the name of the issuing branch specified.
Issuer Code Click the search icon and select the issuer code from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the HO code of the
logged-in branch and the issuer codes maintained
in the Issuer Code Maintenance screen.
Issuer Code Description Displays the description of the specified Issuer Code.
TC Amount Select the TC currency from the drop-down values, and
specify the TC Amount.
Purchase Date Select the purchase date of the TC.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Account Amount Displays the account amount based on the Exchange Rate,
TC Amount, and Account Number selected.
8-156
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the TC currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
4. Specify the TC denomination details. For information on the fields in the TC
Denominations segment, refer to Add TC Denominations to Purchase TC.
5. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
6. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves.
8-157
Chapter 8
Travellers Cheque
8-158
9
Term Deposit Transactions
A deposit with a fixed tenure is called a time deposit or Term Deposits (TD). You can open,
redeem, and top-up a term deposit using the TD transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• TD Account Opening
The Teller can use the TD Account Opening screen to open a term deposit account.
• TD Redemption Against Cash
The Teller can use the TD Redemption Against Cash screen to initiate manual
redemption of the cash from a term deposit account.
• TD Redemption Against Account
The Teller can use the TD Redemption Against Account screen to initiate manual
redemption of the cash from a term deposit account.
• TD Top-Up Against Account
The Teller can use the TD Top-Up Against Account screen to initiate the top-up for a
term deposit account.
• TD Top-Up Against Cash
The Teller can use the TD Top-Up Against Cash screen to initiate the top-up for a term
deposit account.
9-1
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
2. On the TD Account Opening screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer ID Select the Customer ID from the list of values.
Customer Name Displays the name of the specified Customer ID.
Mode of Operation Select the mode of operations from the drop-down list. The
drop-down list shows the following values:
• Single
• Jointly
• Either Anyone or Survivor
• Former or Survivor
• Mandate Holder
Account Type Select the account type (Single or Joint).
Deposit Product Specify the deposit product (FCUBS Account Class) from the
list of values fetched from FLEXCUBE Universal Banking
System.
Deposit Product Displays the description of the specified deposit product.
Description
Deposit Account Specify the description of the deposit account.
Description
Deposit Account Specify the account opening date of the deposit account.
Opening Date
Deposit Amount Specify the currency and amount for the term deposit.
Deposit Tenor Specify the tenor of deposit in days/months/years.
Maturity Amount Displays the maturity amount along with the currency.
9-2
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Field Description
Simulate Click Simulate to fetch the interest data for the given account
class.
Auto-Renewal Select if auto-renewal is required for the deposit account after
maturity.
3. Specify the funding details. For information on the fields in the Funding Details segment,
refer to Add Funding Details.
4. Specify the joint holder details. For information on the fields in the Joint Holders
segment, refer to Add Joint Holders Details.
5. Specify the payout details. For information on the fields in the Payout Details segment,
refer to Add Payout Details.
6. Specify the interest details. For information on the fields in the Interest Details segment,
refer to Add Interest Details.
7. Specify the rollover details. For information on the fields in the Rollover Details segment,
refer to Add Rollover Details.
8. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
Details segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
9. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. When you submit, the transaction details are handed off
to the Term Deposit module in FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the TD
account opening process.
Both TD account opening by cash and TD account opening by account can be
viewed from the electronic journal log after submission.
9-3
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
The pay-by option can be selected as Cash or Account based on the requirement.
To add the funding details:
On the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Pay By Select Account or Cash for the pay-in option.
9-4
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Field Description
Transaction Amount Specify the transaction currency if the Pay By is selected as
Cash.
Note:
By default, branch currency will be
shown and allow for editing. In
addition, the system defaults the
transaction amount based on the
transaction currency selected.
Account Number Specify the account number from which the deposit account
needs to be funded.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
Account Amount Displays the currency of the selected account number and the
calculated account amount based on the exchange rate.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at
Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
9-5
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the deposit currency
into account or transaction currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the deposit currency is the same
as the account or transaction
currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is
displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
This data segment is applicable only if the account type is maintained as Joint.
To add the details of the joint holders:
On the Joint Holders data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
9-6
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Field Description
Joint Holder ID Select the customer ID, which is considered as a joint account holder
for the deposit account.
Joint Holder Name Displays the customer name as joint holder name.
Relationship Select the relationship of the joint account holder from the drop-down
list.
Joint Holder’s Type Select the joint holder’s type from the drop-down list.
In this data segment, you can add the parameters for automatic payout through either
account transfer, banker's cheque, or demand draft.
To add the payout details:
On the Payout Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
9-7
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Component Type Select the component type from the drop-down list. (Principal or
Interest).
Repayment By Select the repayment option from the drop-down list (Account,
Bankers Cheque, or Demand Draft).
Payment Account Specify the account to which the repayment is to be made.
Note:
This field allows you to input only if
repayment is by account.
Account Branch Displays the account branch based on the payment account
selected.
Beneficiary Name Specify the name of the beneficiary for the payout of BC or DD
drawn.
Note:
This field allows you to input only if
the repayment is by BC or DD.
Beneficiary Address 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary for the payout.
Beneficiary Address 4
9-8
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Product Details Displays the details of the deposit product.
Select Select the check box to populate the Effective Date.
Waiver Displays the waiver applicability (Y or N).
Product Status Displays the product status code.
Continue Variance on Displays the following applicability of variance:
Rollover • Y – If the variance is to be continued on rollover.
• N – If the variance is not continued on rollover.
Effective Date Displays the effective date of the deposit product.
Select Select the check box to populate the user-defined values.
Date Displays the effective date.
Status Displays the product status.
User Defined Values Displays the user-defined values of the deposit product.
Element Displays the element code. You can edit the value based on the
requirements.
Value Displays the value. You can edit the value based on the requirements.
9-9
Chapter 9
TD Account Opening
Field Description
Rate Code Displays the rate code. You can edit the value based on the
requirements.
Deposit Rate Code Displays the deposit rate code. You can edit the value based on the
requirements.
Variance Displays the variance. You can edit the value based on the
requirements.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
9-10
Chapter 9
TD Redemption Against Cash
Field Description
Renewal Option Specify the renewal option from the following drop-down values:
• Account Class Tenor
• Account Tenor
• Independent
Note:
This field is mandatory to input if auto-
renewal is selected.
Renewal Type Specify the renewal type from the following drop-down values:
• Principal
• Interest
• Principal + Interest
• Special Amount
Note:
This field is mandatory to input if auto-
renewal is selected.
Note:
The renewal currency is displayed as a
deposit currency.
9-11
Chapter 9
TD Redemption Against Cash
2. On the TD Redemption Against Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Deposit Account Specify the deposit account number.
Query Click Query to fetch the deposit details.
Deposit Details Specify the fields.
Customer ID Displays the Customer ID of the deposit account number.
Account Name Displays the account description of the deposit account.
Principal Amount Click Compute to get the amount paid at the time of term
deposit booking.
Interest Amount Displays the default rate of interest at which the interest
amount is calculated.
Tax Amount Displays the amount to be deducted towards tax.
Interest Rate Click Compute to get the current interest rate applicable after
partial or full redemption.
Maturity Amount Displays the current maturity amount after partial or full
redemption.
Total Payout Amount Displays the total payout amount.
9-12
Chapter 9
TD Redemption Against Cash
Field Description
Redemption Details Specify the fields.
Redemption Mode Select the redemption mode from the drop-down list (Partial
Redemption or Full Redemption).
Redemption Amount Specify as mentioned below:
• If the Redemption Mode is selected as Partial
Redemption, specify the redemption amount.
• If the Redemption Mode is selected as Full
Redemption, it displays the principal amount as
redemption amount.
Waive Penalty Check this box to waive the penalty for redeeming the term
deposit.
Note:
This is applicable only if the Redemption Mode is
selected as Full Redemption.
Waive Interest Check this box to waive the interest for redeeming the term
deposit.
Note:
This is applicable only if the Redemption Mode is
selected as Full Redemption.
Transaction Currency Specify the currency in which the cash is handed over to the
customer during redemption.
Transaction Amount Displays the transaction amount based on the Redemption
Amount and Transaction Currency.
Note:
If the deposit currency is different from the
transaction currency, the system calculates the
transaction amount based on the exchange rate.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
9-13
Chapter 9
TD Redemption Against Account
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate applicable for the transaction
based on the deposit currency and transaction currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. When you submit, the transaction details
are handed off to the Term Deposit module in FLEXCUBE Universal
Banking for the TD redemption process.
9-14
Chapter 9
TD Redemption Against Account
2. On the TD Redemption Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Deposit Account Specify the deposit account number.
Account Branch Displays the branch of the deposit account.
Query Click Query to fetch the deposit details.
Deposit Details Specify the fields.
Customer ID Displays the Customer ID of the deposit account number.
Account Name Displays the account description of the deposit account.
Principal Amount Click Compute to get the amount paid at the time of term deposit
booking.
Interest Amount Displays the default rate of interest at which the interest amount is
calculated.
Tax Amount Displays the amount to be deducted towards tax.
Interest Rate Click Compute to get the current interest rate applicable after
partial or full redemption.
Maturity Amount Displays the current maturity amount after partial/full redemption.
Total Payout Amount Displays the total payout amount.
Redemption Details Specify the fields.
9-15
Chapter 9
TD Redemption Against Account
Field Description
Redemption Mode Select the redemption mode from the drop-down list (Partial
Redemption or Full Redemption).
Redemption Amount Specify as mentioned below:
• If the Redemption Mode is selected as Partial Redemption,
specify the redemption amount.
• If the Redemption Mode is selected as Full Redemption, it
displays the principal amount as redemption amount.
Waive Penalty Check this box to waive the penalty for redeeming the term deposit.
Note:
This is applicable only if the Redemption Mode is
selected as Full Redemption.
Waive Interest Check this box to waive the interest for redeeming the term deposit.
Note:
This is applicable only if the Redemption Mode is
selected as Full Redemption.
Offset Account Specify the offset account number to which the redeemed funds are
to be paid.
Offset Account Amount The system defaults the amount in the offset account number.
Offset Account Branch The system defaults the branch of the offset account number.
Offset Account Name The system defaults the description of the offset account number.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate applicable for the transaction based on
the deposit currency and offset account currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
9-16
Chapter 9
TD Top-Up Against Account
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised when
the transaction saves. When you submit, the transaction details are handed off
to the Term Deposit module in FLEXCUBE Universal Banking for the TD
redemption process.
2. On the TD Top-Up Against Account screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
9-17
Chapter 9
TD Top-Up Against Account
Field Description
Deposit Account Specify the deposit account number for which the top-up
amount is to be added.
Account Branch Displays the branch of the deposit account number.
Query Click Query, to fetch the deposit details.
Deposit Details Specify the fields.
Original Deposit Displays the original deposit amount of the deposit account.
Amount
Principal Balance Displays the principal balance of the deposit account.
Customer ID Displays the customer ID of the deposit account number.
Account Name Displays the account description of the deposit account
number.
Interest Rate Displays the interest rate of the deposit account.
Deposit Tenor Displays the tenor of the deposit account.
Interest Amount Displays the calculated interest amount of the deposit account.
Maturity Amount Displays the amount available on the maturity of the deposit
account.
Top-Up Details Specify the fields.
Offset Account Specify the offset account from which the top-up amount
needs to be debited.
Offset Account Branch Displays the branch of the specified offset account.
Account Amount Displays the top-up amount that is added to the deposit
amount. The top-up currency is defaulted to deposit account
currency.
Value Date Specify the date on which the TD top-up needs to be effective.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Term Deposit Top-Up, and it
can be modified.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. When you submit, the transaction details
are handed off to the Term Deposit module in FLEXCUBE Universal
Banking for the TD top-up processing.
9-18
Chapter 9
TD Top-Up Against Cash
2. On the TD Top-Up Against Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Deposit Account Specify the deposit account number for which the top-up amount
needs to be added.
9-19
Chapter 9
TD Top-Up Against Cash
Field Description
Query Click Query to fetch the deposit details.
Deposit Details Specify the fields.
Original Deposit Amount Displays the principal amount at the time of TD account opening.
Principal Balance Displays the principal balance of the deposit account.
Customer ID Displays the customer ID of the deposit account number.
Account Name Displays the account description of the deposit account number.
Interest Amount Displays the calculated interest amount of the deposit account.
Interest Rate Displays the interest rate of the deposit account.
Deposit Tenor Displays the tenor of the deposit account.
Interest Amount Displays the calculated interest amount of the deposit account.
Maturity Amount Displays the amount available on the maturity of the deposit
account.
Top-Up Details Specify the fields.
Top-Up Amount Specify the top-up amount that is added to the deposit amount. The
top-up currency is defaulted to deposit account currency.
Value Date Specify the date on which the TD top-up needs to be effective.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Term Deposit Top-Up, and it can
be modified.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any warning raised
when the transaction saves. When you submit, the transaction details
are handed off to the Term Deposit module in FLEXCUBE Universal
Banking for the TD top-up processing.
9-20
10
Credit Card Transactions
The Teller can use the screens related to credit card transactions to perform credit card
advances and payments.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Credit Card Advance by Cash
The Teller can use the Advance by Cash screen to disburse the credit card advance in
cash to a walk-in customer against the credit card.
• Credit Card Advance by Transfer
The Teller can use the Advance by Transfer screen to transfer the credit card advance
amount to a customer’s account.
• Credit Card Payment by Cash
The Teller can use the Credit Card Payment by Cash screen to accept cash from a
walk-in customer and make a credit card payment.
• Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
The Teller can use the Credit Card Payment screen to make credit card payments by
debiting a walk-in customer’s account or clearing a cheque.
• Stop Card Request
The Teller can use the Stop Card Request screen to block the credit card of a customer.
10-1
Chapter 10
Credit Card Advance by Cash
2. On the Advance by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Credit Card Specify the credit card number against which the cash
advance is to be made. When you press the Tab key, the
customer details and card details will be displayed in the
Customer Information widget.
Advance Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values and
specify the advance amount.
Advance Tenor Specify the tenor in Days/Months/Years.
10-2
Chapter 10
Credit Card Advance by Cash
Field Description
Document Type Select from the drop-down list. The values in the drop-down
list are mentioned below:
• Address Document
• Identity Document
• Financial Document
• General Document
Document Number Specify the document number.
Note:
This field is mandatory only if the document type is
selected.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
indicator level is set as Y.
Account Amount Display the account amount along with the currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
Total Charges (LCY) Displays the total charges applicable for the cash advance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
10-3
Chapter 10
Credit Card Advance by Transfer
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the cash is disbursed successfully to the walk-in customer against the
credit card.
10-4
Chapter 10
Credit Card Advance by Transfer
2. On the Advance by Transfer screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Credit Card Specify the credit card number against which the cash advance is to
be made. When you press the Tab key, the customer details and
card details will be displayed in the Customer Information widget.
Advance Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values and
specify the advance amount.
Advance Tenor Specify the tenor in Days/Months/Years.
Beneficiary Account Specify the beneficiary account number to which the amount needs
to be transferred.
Beneficiary Name Displays the name based on the specified beneficiary account
number.
10-5
Chapter 10
Credit Card Advance by Transfer
Field Description
Account Branch Displays the branch based on the specified beneficiary account
number.
Document Type Select from the drop-down list. The values in the drop-down list are
mentioned below:
• Address Document
• Identity Document
• Financial Document
• General Document
Document Number Specify the document number.
Note:
This field is mandatory only if the document type is
selected.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Account Amount Display the account amount along with the currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charges applicable for the cash advance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is set
as Y.
10-6
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Cash
Field Description
Narrative Displays the narrative as Advance by Transfer, and it can be
modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the advance
against the credit card is transferred successfully to the account of the walk-in
customer.
10-7
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Cash
2. On the Credit Card Payment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Credit Card Specify the credit card number for which the payment is to be
made. When you press the Tab key, the customer details and
card details will be displayed in the Customer Information
widget.
Payment Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values and
specify the payment amount.
Note:
If Multi-Currency and Total Charges
Configuration are set as Y, then the currency in
the Payment Amount field defaults credit card
currency, and it can be modified. If it is set as N,
then the Payment currency is defaulted and
displayed.
10-8
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Cash
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
indicator level is set as Y.
Credit Amount Display the credit amount along with the currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charges applicable for the credit card
payment.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
10-9
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the credit card payment is done successfully.
10-10
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
2. On the Credit Card Payment by Account screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Payment Mode Select the payment mode as Account.
Credit Card Specify the credit card number for which the payment is to be made.
When you press the Tab key, the customer details and card details
will be displayed in the Customer Information widget.
10-11
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
Field Description
Payment Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values and
specify the payment amount.
Note:
If Multi-Currency and Total Charges
Configuration is set as Y, then the currency in the
Payment Amount field to default credit card currency
and can be modified. If it is set as N, then Payment
currency is defaulted and displayed.
Debit Amount Specify the account number from which the amount is to be debited.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or Stopped
or Invalid cheque.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Credit Amount Display the credit amount along with the currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
10-12
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges applicable for the credit card payment.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is set
as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charges segment, refer to
Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the credit card
payment is done successfully.
10-13
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
2. On the Credit Card Payment by Cheque screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Payment Mode Select the payment mode as Clearing Cheque.
Credit Card Specify the credit card number for which the payment is to be
made. When you press the Tab key, the customer details and
card details will be displayed in the Customer Information
widget.
10-14
Chapter 10
Credit Card Payment by Non-Cash Modes
Field Description
Cheque Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values and
specify the payment amount.
Note:
If Multi-Currency and Total Charges
Configuration is set as Y, then the currency in
Payment Amount field to default credit card
currency and it can be modified. If it is set as N,
then Payment currency is defaulted and displayed.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number from which the amount is to be
drawn.
Cheque Date Specify the date of the cheque.
Routing Number Specify the routing number of the cheque.
Drawer Name Specify the drawer name.
Drawer Account Specify the drawer account number.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
indicator level is set as Y.
Credit Amount Display the credit amount along with the currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
10-15
Chapter 10
Stop Card Request
Field Description
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges applicable for the credit card
payment.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the credit card payment is done successfully.
10-16
Chapter 10
Stop Card Request
2. On the Stop Card Request screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Card Number Specify the credit card number, which needs to be blocked. When
you press the Tab key, the system will fetch and display the
following details:
• Customer ID
• Account Number
• Branch
• Reference Number
Customer ID Displays the Customer ID for the credit card number specified.
Account Number Displays the account number for the credit card number specified.
Branch Displays the branch for the credit card number specified.
Reference Number Displays the reference number for the credit card number specified.
Card Status Select the card status (Active or Inactive) from the drop-down list.
3. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the credit card
will be blocked successfully.
10-17
11
Loan Transactions
The loan transactions are used to perform loan disbursement and loan repayment
transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Loan Disbursement by Cash
The Teller can use the Loan Disbursement by Cash screen to disburse the loan by
cash.
• Loan Repayment by Cash
The Teller can use the Loan Repayment by Cash screen to accept repayment of a loan
by cash.
11-1
Chapter 11
Loan Disbursement by Cash
2. On the Loan Disbursement by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Loan Account Specify the loan account number. When you press the Tab
key, the customer details and loan account details will be
displayed in the Customer Information widget.
Disbursement Amount Select the disbursement currency and specify the
disbursement amount.
Note:
By default, the loan account currency is displayed
as disbursement currency. If Multi-Currency
Configuration is set as Y, it can be modified and
if it is N, then the default value cannot be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charges (LCY) Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charges
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
11-2
Chapter 11
Loan Repayment by Cash
Field Description
Account Amount Displays the total cash to be disbursed to the customer in loan
account currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is
set as Y. If the loan account currency is different
from disbursement currency, then the system will
derive the account amount based on the exchange
rate.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the transaction details are handed off to the respective
product processor to trigger disbursement and on transaction completion, the cash is
disbursed successfully to the walk-in customer against the loan account.
11-3
Chapter 11
Loan Repayment by Cash
2. On the Loan Repayment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Loan Account Specify the loan account number. When you press the Tab
key, the customer details and loan account details will be
displayed in the Customer Information widget.
Repayment Amount Select the repayment currency and specify the repayment
amount.
Note:
By default, the loan account currency is displayed
as repayment currency.
11-4
Chapter 11
Loan Repayment by Cash
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charges (LCY) Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Total Charge
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code indicator level is
set as Y. If the loan account currency is different
from repayment currency, then the system will
derive the account amount based on the exchange
rate.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
11-5
Chapter 11
Loan Repayment by Cash
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves.
On transaction submission, the transaction details are handed off to the respective
product processor to trigger disbursement, and on transaction completion, the loan
amount is repaid successfully.
11-6
12
Islamic Transactions
The Teller can use the following screens to perform various Islamic transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Murabaha Payment by Cash
The Teller can use the Murabaha Payment by Cash screen to accept cash to repay the
Murabaha loan amount.
• Islamic Down Payment by Cash
The Teller can use the Islamic Down Payment by Cash screen to accept down payment
by cash for an Islamic loan account.
• Islamic TD Account Opening
The Teller can use the Islamic TD Account Opening screen to open an Islamic TD
account.
12-1
Chapter 12
Murabaha Payment by Cash
2. On the Murabaha Payment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Murabaha Account Specify the Murabaha account number. When you press the
Tab key, the customer details and Murabaha account details
will be displayed in the Customer Information widget.
Repayment Amount Select the repayment currency and specify the repayment
amount.
Note:
By default, the repayment currency is displayed as
financing account currency. If the Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y, it can be modified, and if it is N,
then the default value cannot be modified.
12-2
Chapter 12
Murabaha Payment by Cash
Field Description
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the
account currency, the system displays the exchange
rate as 1. This field is displayed only if Multi-
Currency Configuration at the Function Code
indicator level is set as Y.
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
Account Amount Displays the repayment amount in loan account currency. This
amount will be derived based on the Repayment Amount and
Exchange Rate.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the Denomination
segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
12-3
Chapter 12
Islamic Down Payment by Cash
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves.
On transaction completion, the loan repayment details are handed off to the
Islamic Financing module using the payment service. It is accomplished by
handing off the entries to the accounting system (Dr Cash GL and Cr Int. Bridge
GL) as maintained in the Accounting Definition screen, and the system updates
the Till cash position.
2. On the Islamic Down Payment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
12-4
Chapter 12
Islamic Down Payment by Cash
Field Description
Financing Account Specify the financing account number. When you press the Tab key,
the customer details and financing account details will be displayed
in the Customer Information widget.
Down Payment Amount Select the down payment currency and specify the amount.
Note:
By default, the down payment currency is displayed as
financing account currency. If the Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y, it can be modified, and if it is N, then the default
value cannot be modified.
Note:
If the transaction currency is the same as the account
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as 1.
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Total Charges Displays the total charges in the branch local currency.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
Account Amount Displays the down payment amount in loan account currency. This
amount will be derived based on the Down Payment Amount and
Exchange Rate.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator level is
set as Y.
12-5
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves.
On transaction completion, the loan repayment details are handed off to the
Islamic Financing module. It is accomplished by handing off entries to the
accounting system (Dr Cash GL and Cr Int. Bridge GL) as maintained in the
Accounting Definition screen, and the system updates the Till cash position.
12-6
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
2. On the Islamic TD Account Opening screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer ID Select the Customer ID from the list of values.
Customer Name Displays the name of the specified Customer ID.
12-7
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
Field Description
Mode of Operation Select the mode of operations from the drop-
down list. The drop-down list shows the
following values:
• Single
• Jointly
• Either Anyone or Survivor
• Former or Survivor
• Mandate Holder
Account Type Select the account type (Single or Joint).
Deposit Product Specify the deposit product. Click Fetch to
select the appropriate product type.
Deposit Product Description Displays the description of the specified deposit
product.
Deposit Account Description Specify the description of the deposit account.
Deposit Account Opening Date Specify the account opening date of the deposit
account.
Deposit Amount Specify the deposit amount along with the
currency.
Deposit Tenor Specify the deposit tenor in Days/Months/Years.
Profit Rate Specify the profit rate.
3. Specify the funding details. For information on the fields in the Funding Details
segment, refer to Add Funding Details for Islamic TD.
4. Specify the joint holder details. For information on the fields in the Joint Holders
segment, refer to Add Joint Holders for Islamic TD.
5. Specify the payout details. For information on the fields in the Payout Details
segment, refer to Add Payout Details for Islamic TD.
6. Specify the rollover details. For information on the fields in the Rollover Details
segment, refer to Add Rollover Details for Islamic TD.
7. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
8. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the loan repayment details are handed off to the Islamic Financing TD
module for account creation.
12-8
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
12-9
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
The pay-by option can be selected as Cash or Account based on the requirement.
To add the funding details:
On the Funding Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Pay By Select Account or Cash for the pay-in option.
Account Number Specify the account number from which the deposit account
needs to be funded.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
Account Amount Displays the currency of the selected account number and the
calculated account amount based on the exchange rate.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
12-10
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
Field Description
Cheque Date Specify the date as mentioned in the cheque.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the
Pay By is selected as Account.
Note:
By default, branch currency will be
shown and allow for editing. In
addition, the system defaults the
transaction amount based on the
transaction currency selected.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate used to convert the deposit currency
into account or transaction currency, and it can be modified.
Note:
If the deposit currency is the same
as the account or transaction
currency, the system will display the
exchange rate as 1. This field is
displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code
Indicator level is set as Y.
12-11
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
This data segment is applicable only if the account type is maintained as Joint.
To add the details of the joint holders:
On the Joint Holders data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Joint Holder ID Select the customer ID which is considered as joint account
holder for the deposit account.
Joint Holder Name Displays the customer name as joint holder name.
Relationship Select the relationship of the joint account holder from the drop-
down list.
Joint Holder’s Type Select the joint holder’s type from the drop-down list.
12-12
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
In this data segment, you can add the parameters for automatic payout through either
account transfer, banker's cheque, or demand draft.
To add the payout details:
On the Payout Details data segment, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Component Type Select the component type from the drop-down list. (Principal or
Profit).
Repayment By Select the repayment option from the drop-down list (Account,
Bankers Cheque, or Demand Draft).
Payment Account Specify the account to which the repayment is to be made. This field
allows you to input only if repayment is by account.
Account Branch Displays the account branch based on the payment account selected.
Beneficiary Name Specify the name of the beneficiary for the payout of BC or DD drawn.
Note:
This field allows you to input only if the
repayment is by BC or DD.
Beneficiary Address 1 to Specify the address of the beneficiary for the payout.
Beneficiary Address 4
12-13
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Auto Renewal Select if auto-renewal is required for the deposit account.
12-14
Chapter 12
Islamic TD Account Opening
Field Description
Renewal Type Specify the renewal type from the following drop-down values:
• Principal
• Principal + Profit
• Special Amount
• Profit
Note:
This field is mandatory to input if
auto-renewal is selected.
Note:
The renewal currency is displayed
as the deposit currency.
12-15
13
Bill Payments
The bill payment transactions are used to make payments for various utility bills.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Bill Payment by Cash
The Teller can use the Bill Payment by Cash screen to make utility bill payments by
cash.
• Bill Payments by Other Modes
The bill payment transactions are used to make payments for various utility bills. Utility
bill payments can be performed for the Institutions, which are already maintained in
product processors. The bill payment can be made by account and clearing cheque.
2. On the Bill Payment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
13-1
Chapter 13
Bill Payment by Cash
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Utility Provider ID Click the search icon, and select the utility provider ID from the
list of values.
Settlement Account Displays the account number of the specified utility provider ID.
Account Currency Displays the account currency of the settlement account.
Account Description Displays the account description of the settlement account.
Utility Provider Name Displays the name of the specified utility provider ID.
Consumer Number Specify the consumer number.
Bill Number Specify the bill number.
Bill Date Specify the bill date.
Bill Amount Select the currency from the drop-down values, and specify
the bill amount that needs to be paid.
Transaction Amount Select the transaction currency from the drop-down values.
The transaction amount is displayed based on the exchange
rate.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the bill currency is the same as the Transaction
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Specify the denomination details. For information on the fields in the
Denomination segment, refer to Add Denomination Details.
5. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
13-2
Chapter 13
Bill Payments by Other Modes
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the main leg
accounting (Dr Cash GL and Cr Institution ID account GL) and charge
accounting details are handed off to the Accounting System.
Note:
By default, the system displays the Bill Payment by Account screen.
13-3
Chapter 13
Bill Payments by Other Modes
2. On the Bill Payment by Account screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Payment Mode Select the payment mode type from the drop-down list. The
values are:
• Account
• Clearing Cheque
Utility Provider ID Click the search icon, and select the utility provider ID from the
list of values.
Utility Provider Name Displays the name of the specified utility provider ID.
Settlement Account Displays the account number of the specified utility provider ID.
Account Currency Displays the account currency of the settlement account.
Account Description Displays the account description of the settlement account.
Consumer Number Specify the consumer number.
Bill Number Specify the bill number.
Bill Date Specify the bill date.
Bill Amount Select the currency from the drop-down values, and specify
the bill amount that needs to be paid.
Account Number Specify the account number against which the bill payment
needs to be done.
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
13-4
Chapter 13
Bill Payments by Other Modes
Field Description
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number, if the amount needs to be debited
through the cheque.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Cheque Date Specify the cheque date, if the amount needs to be debited
through the cheque.
Account Amount Displays the amount that needs to be debited based on the
exchange rate.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the bill currency is the same as the Transaction
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the main leg
accounting (Dr Cash GL and Cr Institution ID account GL) and charge
accounting details are handed off to the Accounting System.
13-5
Chapter 13
Bill Payments by Other Modes
Note:
By default, the system displays the Bill Payment by Account screen.
2. On the Bill Payment by Clearing Cheque screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Payment Mode Select the payment mode type from the drop-down list. The
values are:
• Account
• Clearing Cheque
13-6
Chapter 13
Bill Payments by Other Modes
Field Description
Utility Provider ID Click the search icon, and select the utility provider ID from the
list of values.
Utility Provider Name Displays the name of the specified utility provider ID.
Settlement Account Displays the account number of the specified utility provider ID.
Account Currency Displays the account currency of the settlement account.
Account Description Displays the account description of the settlement account.
Consumer Number Specify the consumer number.
Bill Number Specify the bill number.
Bill Date Specify the bill date.
Bill Amount Select the currency from the drop-down values, and specify
the bill amount that needs to be paid.
Cheque Amount Displays the currency and bill amount value.
Clearing Type Click Search icon, and select clearing network code from the
drop-down values.
Routing Number Specify the routing number.
Drawer Account Specify the drawer account.
Drawer Name Specify the drawer name.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number, if the amount needs to be debited
through the cheque.
Note:
The system validates the status of the cheque and
prompts an error message if incase of a Used or
Stopped or Invalid cheque.
Cheque Date Specify the cheque date, if the amount needs to be debited
through the cheque.
Account Amount Displays the amount that needs to be debited based on the
exchange rate.
Exchange Rate Displays the exchange rate.
Note:
If the bill currency is the same as the Transaction
currency, the system displays the exchange rate as
1. This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code indicator
level is set as Y.
13-7
Chapter 13
Bill Payments by Other Modes
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion,
the main leg accounting (Dr Cash GL and Cr Institution ID account GL)
and charge accounting details are handed off to the Accounting System.
13-8
14
Session Teller Transactions
The Teller can use the screens under the Teller Session menu to perform financial
transactions for customer accounts in a teller session.
The cash transactions can be performed only when the teller session is started, refer to Start
Teller Session to start a teller session. The Teller can enter the denomination details for a
teller session in the Stop Teller Session screen. Denomination tracking must be enabled for
this functionality.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Cash Deposit
The Cash Deposit screen is used to deposit the cash in a CASA through a Teller
Session.
• Cash Withdrawal
The Cash Withdrawal screen is used to withdraw funds from the CASA account of the
customer.
• FX Sale Against Walk-in
The FX Sale Against Walk-in screen is used to sell a foreign currency to a walk-in
customer in return for the equivalent amount received in another currency.
• FX Purchase Against Walk-in
The FX Purchase Against Walk-in screen is used to buy foreign currency from walk-in
customers.
• Loan Repayment by Cash
The Teller can use the Loan Repayment by Cash screen to accept cash from a walk-in
customer to repay the loan amount.
14-1
Chapter 14
Cash Withdrawal
2. On the Cash Deposit screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to Table 4-1.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit. For more information on transaction submission and validations,
refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
The Transaction Completed Successfully information message is
displayed.
14-2
Chapter 14
Cash Withdrawal
1. On the Homepage, click Teller. On the Teller Mega Menu, under Session Teller
Transactions, click Cash Withdrawal or specify the Cash Withdrawal in the search
icon bar and select the screen.
The Cash Withdrawal screen is displayed.
2. On the Cash Withdrawal screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to Table 4-3.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves.
14-3
Chapter 14
FX Sale Against Walk-in
2. On the FX Sale Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to Table 4-6.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
14-4
Chapter 14
FX Purchase Against Walk-in
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves.
On transaction completion, the teller cash position to the equivalent of Sold currency is
deducted, and Received currency is incremented. For more information on transaction
submission and validations, refer to Step 5 in Cash Deposit.
14-5
Chapter 14
FX Purchase Against Walk-in
2. On the FX Purchase Against Walk-in screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to Table 4-8.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval
warning raised when the transaction saves.
14-6
Chapter 14
Loan Repayment by Cash
2. On the Loan Repayment by Cash screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to Table 11-2.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
A teller sequence number is generated, and the Transaction Completed
Successfully information message is displayed.
Note:
The transaction is moved to authorization in case of any approval warning
raised when the transaction saves. On transaction completion, the loan amount
is repaid successfully.
14-7
15
Journal Log
The Teller or Supervisor can use screens under the Journal Log menu to view the status of
transactions performed by them. It is also used to resubmit or reject an incomplete
transaction or reverse a completed transaction.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• About Electronic and Servicing Journals
In the Electronic Journal and Servicing Journal screens, Tellers can view the status of
the transactions performed only by them and Supervisors can view the status of the
transactions performed by them and other Tellers.
• Electronic Journal
Tellers and Supervisors can use the Electronic Journal screen to view the status of the
cash transactions performed by them on the posting date.
• Servicing Journal
Tellers and Supervisors can use this screen to view the status of the non-cash
transactions performed by them on the posting date.
• Reassign Transactions
Tellers and Supervisors can use the Reassign Transactions screen to re-assign the
transactions that are pending approval to the other Supervisor or to unlock a locked
transaction.
Common Operations
These screens are used to perform the following operations:
Operation Description
View Status View the status of all transactions performed by the logged-
in Teller ID.
Reverse Completed Transactions Reverse the completed transaction posted by Teller during
the day.
Re-submit Incomplete Transactions Re-submit the incomplete transactions performed by the
logged-in Teller ID, that are either:
• Approved by the supervisor and moved to Teller EJ log
for re-submission.
• Processed by an external system (for example, Oracle
Banking Payments) and responded to Teller with the
status as Success.
15-1
Chapter 15
About Electronic and Servicing Journals
Operation Description
Reject Incomplete Transactions Reject the incomplete transactions that are either:
• Rejected by an external system (for example, Oracle
Banking Payments) with the status as Reject.
• Prompted with error due to processing validations.
View Approval History View the approval history to see the list of all transactions
that are either approved or rejected by the logged-in
approver ID.
Approve or Reject Transactions Approve or Reject the transactions that are assigned to the
logged-in Approver ID during the day.
Discard of Reversal Transactions When the approver rejects the reversal request, the
transaction is marked as rejected and the teller discards the
rejected status, the transaction is moved to the discarded
transaction.
In the tile and grid views, the transactions are displayed for all statuses by default. The
status can be changed using the filters option. If the user closes the screen with a
status other than All, the selected status will default until the browser tab is closed.
The following conditions apply for the default status:
Condition Description
The browser tab is not closed The transactions will be displayed for the
previously selected status if the screen is
launched again.
The browser tab is closed and the user The transactions will be displayed for all
logs in to the application in a new tab or statuses if the screen is launched.
window
Icon Description
Click on this icon to display the details in the tile view.
After filling the necessary fields in the Electronic Journal and Servicing Journal
screens, you can do one of the following steps:
15-2
Chapter 15
Electronic Journal
Action Description
Fetch Click Fetch to get the list of transactions based on the query criteria
specified. When you click Fetch, the following details are displayed for
each transaction:
• Function Code and Screen Name
• Transaction Reference Number
• Teller Sequence Number
• Transaction Amount
• Account Number
• Teller ID
• Teller Remarks
Clear Click Clear to clear the specified values.
Users can also navigate to necessary the transaction; perform the operations using the
shortcut keys as follows:
1. Press the Tab key, and navigate to the list of transactions in grid view.
2. Use Up/Down arrow keys to select the necessary transaction.
3. Use Left/Right arrow keys to select the icon.
4. Press Spacebar to view the operations applicable to the selected transaction.
5. Use Up/Down arrow keys to select the necessary operation.
15-3
Chapter 15
Electronic Journal
• Click icon to view the transaction information. This screen provides the
details of the transactions handed off to the external system.
• Click icon to view the transaction details. The following details are
displayed based on the transaction status in the filters:
– Teller Sequence
– Transaction Reference
– Transaction Status
– Time Resubmitted
– Time Stamp/Approval Time Stamp
– Supervisor ID
– Supervisor Remarks
– Override Info
Click Override Info icon to view the details for approval flow request.
15-4
Chapter 15
Electronic Journal
2. Click the icon to filter the results on the tile/grid view based on the search criteria.
The Filters pop-up screen is displayed.
3. On the Filters pop-up screen, specify the details fetch the records. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
15-5
Chapter 15
Electronic Journal
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Teller ID Specify the Teller ID.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select the
Teller ID from the list of values.
Function Code Specify the function code for which the inquiry is to be made.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select the
Teller ID from the list of values.
Branch Posting Date Specify the branch posting date for which the inquiry is to be
made.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select the
Teller ID from the list of maintained account
numbers.
Teller Sequence Prefix Click the search icon and select from the list of values.
Transaction Status Select the transaction status from the drop-down values.
Note:
By default, All status is selected.
15-6
Chapter 15
Servicing Journal
Field Description
Transaction Reference Specify the transaction reference number.
From Sequence Specify the start number of the sequence range.
Number
To Sequence Number Specify the end number of the sequence range.
From Transaction Time Specify the transaction start time.
To Transaction Time Specify the transaction end time.
From Amount Range Specify the “from” amount of the amount range.
To Amount Range Specify the “to” amount of the amount range.
Transaction Currency Click the search icon and select the transaction currency from
the list of values.
• Click icon to view the transaction information. This screen provides the details
of the transactions handed off to the external system.
15-7
Chapter 15
Servicing Journal
• Click icon to view the transaction details. The following details are
displayed based on the transaction status in the filters:
– Teller Sequence
– Transaction Reference
– Transaction Status
– Time Resubmitted
– Time Stamp/Approval Time Stamp
– Supervisor ID
– Supervisor Remarks
– Override Info
Click Override Info icon to view the details for approval flow request.
2. Click the icon to filter the results on the tile/grid view based on the search
criteria.
15-8
Chapter 15
Servicing Journal
3. On the Filters pop-up screen, specify the details fetch the records. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Teller ID Specify the Teller ID.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select the Teller ID
from the list of values.
15-9
Chapter 15
Servicing Journal
Field Description
Function Code Specify the function code for which the inquiry is to be made.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select the Teller ID
from the list of values.
Branch Posting Date Specify the branch posting date for which the inquiry is to be made.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select the Teller ID
from the list of maintained account numbers.
Teller Sequence Prefix Click the search icon and select from the list of values.
Transaction Status Select the transaction status from the drop-down values.
Note:
By default, All status is selected.
15-10
Chapter 15
Reassign Transactions
2. On the Reassign Transactions screen, specify the details fetch the records. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Posting Date Specify the branch posting date for which the inquiry is to be made.
Note:
By default, the current posting date is displayed.
15-11
Chapter 15
Reassign Transactions
Field Description
Function Code Specify the function code for which the inquiry is to be made.
Note:
You can also click the search icon and select from the list
of the maintained function codes.
Note:
The LOV fetches a list of the maintained account
numbers.
3. After you specify the necessary fields, you can perform one of the following
actions:
Action Description
Fetch Click Fetch to get the list of transactions based on the query
criteria specified. When you click Fetch, the following details
are displayed for each transaction:
• Function Code and Screen Name
• Transaction Reference Number
• Teller Sequence Number
• Transaction Amount
• Account Number
• Teller ID
• Supervisor ID
• Teller Remarks
• Supervisor Remarks
Clear Click Clear to clear the transaction list.
15-12
Chapter 15
Reassign Transactions
The transactions fetched based on the search criteria are displayed in Tile View. In the
Tile View, you can click the necessary icons to perform the operations.
In the transaction record, you can perform one of the following operations:
Action Description
15-13
16
Prediction
The screen under the Prediction menu is used to predict the number of service counters.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Teller Service Counters Prediction
The Teller Service Counters Prediction screen is used to predict the number of Teller
service counters required for the specified days.
2. On the Teller Service Counters Prediction screen, specify the details fetch the records.
For more information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Current Service Time Specify the time to service business transactions at the Teller
(Minutes) counter.
Branch Customer Lounge Specify the number of persons that can be accommodated at one
Capacity (Persons) time in the physical service area of the Branch.
16-1
Chapter 16
Teller Service Counters Prediction
Field Description
Physical Teller Counters Specify the physical teller counters available at the branch.
(Number)
Planned Queue Waiting Specify the waiting time to be achieved at the queue.
Time (Minutes)
Prediction Days Specify the number of days in the future where the Teller counters
are required to be predicted.
3. Click Go.
The predicted value of Teller service counters is displayed. A sample prediction of
Teller service counters based on certain values is shown below.
16-2
17
Cache
The screen under the Cache menu is used to get the maintenance reflected while performing
the transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Clear Cache
The Clear Cache screen is used to clear the cache to get the maintenance reflected
while performing the transactions.
17-1
18
Customer Service
The screens under the Customer Service menu are used for customer services and
inquiries.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Cheque Status Inquiry
The Teller can use the Cheque Status Inquiry screen to query the details of a cheque by
specifying the account number and cheque number of the customer.
• Stop Cheque Request
The Teller can use the Stop Cheque Request screen to initiate stop payment of cheque
as requested by the customer.
• Cheque Book Request
The Cheque Book Request screen is used to initiate the cheque book request for a
customer account.
• Passbook Issue
The Teller can use the Passbook Issue screen to issue a new passbook for a customer
account.
• Passbook Update
The Teller can use the Passbook Update screen to update the passbook of a customer
account.
• Passbook Status Change
The Teller can use the Passbook Status Change screen to initiate the status change for
a passbook of a customer account.
• Passbook Reprint
The Teller can use the Passbook Reprint screen to reprint the passbook of a customer
account.
• Account Balance Inquiry
The Teller can use the Account Balance Inquiry screen to inquire about the account
balance details of a customer account.
• Account Statement Request
The Teller can use the Account Statement Request screen to initiate an account
statement request for a customer account.
• Customer Address Update
The Teller can use the Customer Address Update screen to initiate a service request to
update the customer address details.
• Account Address Update
The Teller can use the Account Address Update screen to initiate a service request to
update the address details of the customer account.
• Customer Contact Update
The Customer Contact Update screen is used to initiate a service request to update the
customer contact details.
18-1
Chapter 18
Cheque Status Inquiry
2. On the Cheque Status Inquiry screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the cheque status
needs to be enquired.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number.
18-2
Chapter 18
Stop Cheque Request
Field Description
Query Click Query to fetch the details of the cheque.
Clear Click Clear to clear the details.
Account Name Displays the name of the account holder.
Account Branch Displays the account branch code.
Customer ID Displays the customer ID of the account.
Cheque Status Displays the status of the cheque (Used, Unused, or
Stopped).
Value Date Displays the date specified on the cheque.
Cheque Amount Displays the cheque amount.
Beneficiary Displays the name of the beneficiary.
18-3
Chapter 18
Cheque Book Request
2. On the Stop Cheque Request screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which you need to enforce a
stop payment.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number on which the stop payment is to
be enforced.
Select Multiple Cheques Select this option to enforce stop payment on multiple cheques
of the customer account.
Cheque Amount Specify the cheque amount for which the cheque is drawn.
The cheque currency is defaulted to account currency.
Effective Date Specify the date on which the cheque is drawn.
Expiry Date Specify the expiry date of the cheque.
Reason Type Specify the type of stop payment (Stop or Lost).
Total Charge Amount Displays the total charge amount, which is computed by the
system in the local currency of the branch.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at the Function Code Indicator
level is set as Y.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
The request is handed off to the core FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system to
update the stop payment status in Customer Accounts Maintenance to indicate the
presence of a stop payment instruction for the customer account.
18-4
Chapter 18
Cheque Book Request
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Customer Service, click Cheque
Book Request or specify Cheque Book Request in the search icon bar and select the
screen.
The Cheque Book Request screen is displayed.
2. On the Cheque Book Request screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the cheque book request is to
be initiated.
Cheque Book Type Click the search icon, and select the checkbook type from the list of
values.
Number of Leaves Select the number of leaves from the following drop-down values:
• 10
• 25
• 50
• 100
First Cheque Number Specify the number of the first cheque.
Request Date By default, the current posting date is displayed as the request date.
18-5
Chapter 18
Passbook Issue
Field Description
Request Status Select the request status from the drop-down values (Requested or
Delivered).
Deliver To Specify the mode of delivery (Branch or Post).
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the Customer if the delivery mode is selected
Address Line 4 as Post.
Note:
By default, the address of the customer account is
displayed, and it can be modified.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Cheque Book Request, and it can
be modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
The request is handed off to the core FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system for
the cheque book issuance of the customer account.
18-6
Chapter 18
Passbook Issue
2. On the Passbook Issue screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the passbook needs to be
issued.
Account Currency Displays the currency of the specified account number.
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
Account Branch Displays the branch code of the specified account number.
Account Open Date Displays the account opening date.
Customer ID Displays the customer ID.
Address Line 1 to Specify the address of the customer.
Address Line 4
18-7
Chapter 18
Passbook Update
Field Description
Passbook Number Displays the passbook number that needs to be issued.
Note:
The passbook number is generated based on the
instrument number maintenance.
Note:
This field is displayed only if Multi-Currency
Configuration at Function Code Indicator level is set
as Y.
Passbook Category Click the search icon, and select the passbook category from the
list of values.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Passbook Issue, and it can be
modified.
Old Passbook Details Specify the fields.
Passbook Number Displays the old passbook number that is issued to the customer
account.
Issue Date Displays the issue date of the old passbook.
Status Movement Displays the current status of the passbook.
Status Change Date Displays the date on which the current status got modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details
segment, refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
The passbook issue request is handed off to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking
system to update the passbook issue request for the customer account.
18-8
Chapter 18
Passbook Update
2. On the Passbook Update screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields, refer
to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the passbook needs to be
updated.
Account Branch Displays the branch code of the specified account number.
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
Passbook Number Displays the passbook number that needs to be updated.
Start Line Specify the start line of the passbook to enter the transaction
details.
Previous Balance Displays the previous balance in the passbook.
Compression Required Check this box to modify the defaulted values related to transaction
compression.
Compression Start Date Displays the compression start date.
Compression End Date Displays the compression end date.
3. Click Submit.
18-9
Chapter 18
Passbook Status Change
The request is handed off to the core FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system to
fetch and update the passbook statement of the customer account.
2. On the Passbook Status Change screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the passbook status
change is required.
Account Branch Displays the branch code of the specified account number.
18-10
Chapter 18
Passbook Reprint
Field Description
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
Customer ID Displays the customer ID of the specified account number.
Passbook Number Displays the current passbook number of the customer
account.
Issue Date Displays the date of issue of the current passbook number.
Passbook Status Select the passbook status to be changed from the following
drop-down values:
• Active
• Close
• Reissue
Status Description Displays the description of the selected status.
Status Change Date Displays the current posting date as the status change date.
Narrative Displays default the narrative as Passbook Status Change,
and it can be modified.
Old Passbook Details Specify the fields.
Passbook Number Displays the old passbook number of the customer account.
Issue Date Displays the issue date of the old passbook.
Status Movement Displays the current status of the old passbook number.
Status Description Displays the description of the status of the old passbook
number.
Status Change Date Displays the date on which the old passbook is modified.
3. Click Submit.
The request is handed off to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system for updating the
status change of the old passbook number.
18-11
Chapter 18
Passbook Reprint
2. On the Passbook Reprint screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the passbook needs to
be updated.
Account Branch Displays the branch code of the specified account number.
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
Account Currency Displays the account currency.
Reprint Basis Select the reprint basis from the following options:
• Reporting Based on Transaction
• Reporting Based on Date
18-12
Chapter 18
Account Balance Inquiry
Field Description
Last Number of Specify the last number of transactions.
Transactions
Note:
This field is enabled only if Reprint Basis is
selected as Transaction.
From Date Specify the date from which the transactions need to be
printed.
Note:
This field is enabled only if Reprint Basis is
selected as Date.
Note:
This field is enabled only if Reprint Basis is
selected as Date.
3. Click Submit.
The request is handed off to the core FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system to fetch the
details and reprint the passbook of the customer account.
18-13
Chapter 18
Account Balance Inquiry
2. On the Account Balance Inquiry screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Account Specify the account number for which the account balance
needs to be enquired.
Query Click Query to fetch and display the details.
Clear Click Clear to clear the details.
Account Currency Displays the currency for which the account balance needs to
be enquired.
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
Account Class Displays the account class of the specified account number.
Account Class Displays the description of the account class.
Description
Account Open Date Displays the date on which the account is opened.
Account Type Displays the type of the account.
Mode of Operation Displays the mode of operation.
Balance Details Specify the fields.
Current Balance Displays the current balance of the account.
18-14
Chapter 18
Account Balance Inquiry
Field Description
Uncollected Displays the uncollected balance.
Blocked Displays the blocked balance.
Available Displays the balance available in the specified account.
Total Available Displays the total available balance.
Book Balance Displays the book balance.
Sweep Enabled Check this box if sweep needs to be enabled.
Sweep Eligible Balance Displays the sweep eligible balance.
ILM Sweep Eligible Displays the ILM sweep eligible balance.
Balance
Temporary Overdraft Displays the temporary overdraft limit.
Limit
Net Balance Displays the net balance.
Passbook Balance Displays the passbook balance.
Account Status Specify the fields.
Posting Allowed Select this checkbox if posting is allowed for the account.
Stop Payment Select this checkbox if stop payment is allowed for the
account.
No Credit Select this checkbox if credit is not allowed for the account.
Debit Override Select this checkbox if debit override is allowed for the
account.
Overdraft Select this checkbox if the overdraft is allowed for the account.
Dormant Select this checkbox if the account is dormant.
Frozen Select this checkbox if the account is frozen.
No Debit Select this checkbox if the debit is not allowed for the account.
Credit Override Select this checkbox if credit override is allowed for the
account.
Status Change Select this checkbox if the automatic status change is allowed.
Automatic
18-15
Chapter 18
Account Statement Request
4. On the Interest and Charges Details segment, view the details. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Accrued Interest (Dr) Displays the debit accrued interest.
Accrued Interest (Cr) Displays the credit accrued interest.
Interest Due Displays the interest due.
Charges Due Displays the charges due.
Last Interest Debit Displays the last interest debit.
Last Interest Credit Displays the last interest credit.
Last DR Activity Displays the last DR activity.
6. On the Turnover Details segment, view the details. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Field Description
Opening Displays the opening turnover details.
Daily Turnover (Dr) Displays the debit daily turnover.
Daily Turnover (Cr) Displays the credit daily turnover.
Current (ACY) Displays the current (ACY).
18-16
Chapter 18
Account Statement Request
2. On the Account Statement Request screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Account Specify the account number for which the account statement needs
to be requested.
Account Name Displays the name of the specified account number.
Request Date Displays the current posting date as the request date.
Statement Type Specify the type of statement requested (Detailed or Summary).
From Date Specify the start date for the date range.
To Date Specify the end date for the date range.
Balance Type Specify if the account statement needs to be generated based on
Book Date or Value Date.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Account Statement, and it can be
modified.
3. Specify the charge details. For information on the fields in the Charge Details segment,
refer to Add Charge Details.
4. Click Submit.
The request is handed off to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system to initiate an
account statement request.
18-17
Chapter 18
Customer Address Update
2. On the Customer Address Update screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Number Specify the customer number for which the address details
need to be updated.
Customer Name Displays the customer name for the customer number
specified.
Correspondence Specify the fields.
Address
Address Line 1 to Displays the maintained address details, and it can be
Address Line 4 modified.
Country Code Displays the maintained address details, and it can be
modified.
18-18
Chapter 18
Account Address Update
Field Description
Permanent Address Specify the fields.
Same as Select this checkbox to populate the Correspondence
Correspondence Address to Permanent Address.
Address
Address Line 1 to Displays the maintained address details, and it can be
Address Line 4 modified.
Country Code Displays the maintained Country code, and it can be modified.
Residential Address Specify the fields.
Same as Permanent Select this checkbox to populate the Permanent Address
Address details to Residential Address.
Address Line 1 to Displays the maintained address details, and it can be
Address Line 4 modified.
Country Code Displays the maintained country code, and it can be modified.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Customer Address Update,
and it can be modified.
Review and Submit Click Review and Submit to review the request details and
submit.
3. Click Submit.
The request details are handed off to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system for the
customer address update.
18-19
Chapter 18
Account Address Update
2. On the Account Address Update screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Number Specify the customer account number for which the address
details need to be updated.
Account Branch Displays the customer name for the customer number
specified.
Correspondence Specify the fields.
Address
Address Line 1 to Displays the maintained address details, and it can be
Address Line 4 modified.
Country Code Displays the maintained address details, and it can be
modified.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Account Address Update,
and it can be modified.
Review and Submit Click Review and Submit to review the request details and
submit.
3. Click Submit.
The request details are handed off to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system
for the account address update.
18-20
Chapter 18
Customer Contact Update
2. On the Customer Contact Update screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Number Specify the customer number for which the contact details need to
be updated.
Customer Name Displays the customer name for the customer number specified.
Customer Details Specify the fields.
Mobile Phone Displays the mobile number, and it can be modified.
Work Phone Displays the work phone number, and it can be modified.
Residential Phone Displays the residential phone number, and it can be modified.
Fax Phone Displays the fax phone number, and it can be modified.
18-21
Chapter 18
Cheque Book Status Change
Field Description
Preferred Contact Time Displays the preferred contact time, and it can be modified.
Preferred Communication Displays the communication mode, and it can be modified.
Mode
Email Address Displays the email id of the customer, and it can be modified.
Alternate Email Address Displays the alternate email id of the customer, and it can be
modified.
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Contact Details Update, and it
can be modified.
Review and Submit Click Review and Submit to review the request details and submit.
3. Click Submit.
The request details are handed off to the FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system
for updating customer contact details.
2. On the Cheque Book Status Change screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
18-22
Chapter 18
Cheque Book Status Change
Field Description
Account Number Specify the account number for which the cheque book status
needs to be changed.
First Cheque Number Specify the number of the first cheque.
Request Status Select the status that needs to be updated for the cheque book. The
drop-down values are as follows:
• Delivered
• Requested
• Destroyed
Narrative Displays the default narrative as Cheque Book Status Change,
and it can be modified.
3. Click Submit.
The request is handed off to the core FLEXCUBE Universal Banking system to change
the status of the cheque book.
18-23
19
Branch Dashboard
The Branch Dashboard facilitates the integration of data from multiple screens and displays it
as a dashboard on the application landing page.
It provides a comprehensive and consolidated snapshot in tiny windows to access
information quickly. Thus, helping the bank staff to analyze, monitor, and make better
decisions, which in turn helps to save time and cost. To access the Branch Dashboard, select
Dashboard from the main menu.
The Branch Dashboard is designed to display the widgets distributed in rows without the
vertical scroll bar. The widgets are as follows:
• Till Cash Position
• Inventory in Hand
• My Transaction Status
• Customer Search
• Current Till Position
• Frequent Customer Operations
• Frequent Branch Operations
• Customer Service Request
• Notifications
• Alerts
• Frequent Links
19-1
Chapter 19
Inventory in Hand
This widget displays the list of inventory counts available with the branch for the
logged-in Teller Id.
My Transaction Status
This widget displays the total transaction count performed by the logged-in Teller. Each
slice represents the status-wise count of the transactions performed by the Teller.
The FILTERS option can be used to display transaction status based on the branch
code, branch date, and transaction type (Cash/Non-Cash).
19-2
Chapter 19
Customer Search
The Teller can use this widget to query and find a specific customer account. For more
information on this segment, refer to Customer Search.
19-3
Chapter 19
Note:
The system displays an error message stating that the User does not have
rights to access this screen if the user is trying to access the restricted
screen in the widget.
19-4
Chapter 19
Note:
The system displays an error message stating that the User does not have rights to
access this screen if the user is trying to access the restricted screen in the widget.
Note:
The system displays an error message stating that the User does not have rights to
access this screen if the user is trying to access the restricted screen in the widget.
Notifications
The Teller can use this widget to view the bank-specific notifications or instructions provided
for the bank staff. Generation of the notifications to be configured at the back-end.
19-5
Chapter 19
19-6
Chapter 19
Alerts
The Teller is alerted through this widget on the user-specific information based on which the
Teller has to act accordingly. Generation of the alerts to be configured at the back-end.
19-7
Chapter 19
19-8
Chapter 19
Frequent Links
The Teller can use this widget to access the frequently used links to refer for transaction
submission and other operational activities during the day.
19-9
20
Branch Maintenance
The branch maintenance screens are used to perform the maintenance for processing the
branch transactions.
This topic contains the following subtopics:
• Common Actions for Branch Maintenance
The screens under the Branch Maintenance menu contain common icons to perform all
or a few of the basic actions.
• Maintain Teller Branch Parameters
The Teller Branch Parameters Maintenance screen is used to set the teller preferences
for a branch.
• Maintain Branch Role Limits
The Branch Role Limits screen is used to set the input and authorization limits for a
specific role.
• Maintain Branch User Preferences
The Branch User Limits screen is used to set preferences like Till/Vault Indicator,
currency holding preferences, and currency limit preferences for the branch user.
• Maintain Denominations
The Denominations Maintenance screen is used to maintain the standard currency
denominations for each currency that the bank deals with.
• Maintain Function Code Definitions
The Function Code Definition screen is used to specify the preferences for the function
code.
• Maintain Function Code Preferences
The Function Code Preferences screen is used to define the workflow preferences
(validation preferences and authorization preferences) for a function code.
• Maintain Default Authorizer
The Default Authorizer screen is used to define the default authorizer who can authorize
a specific function code for a branch user.
• Maintain Accounting and Settlements
The Settlements Definition screen is used to define the settlement and accounting
parameters that are applicable for processing the branch transactions involving a function
code.
• Maintain Instrument Numbers
The Instrument Number Maintenance screen is used to maintain the instrument type
for each branch.
• Maintain Inter Branch Transit Account
The Inter Branch Transit Account screen is used to maintain inter-branch transit
account for each branch using the receiving branch, vault, and currency combination.
• Maintain External System
The External System Maintenance screen is used to define the parameters for the
external system.
20-1
Chapter 20
20-2
Chapter 20
Common Actions for Branch Maintenance
Icon Description
Click this icon to search the configured records based on the specified
search criteria. The input fields to search the records are displayed
based on the maintenance screen.
Click this icon to reset the search results to the default summary view.
Icon Description
Save Click Save to view the configured details in the summary view.
Cancel Click Cancel to terminate the operation.
On the records displayed in the summary view, you can perform one of the following actions:
Action Description
New Create a new record.
Unlock Modify the details and save.
Delete Delete an unauthorized record.
Authorize Authorize the record.
Close Close the record.
Reopen Re-open a closed record.
Audit Audit the record.
20-3
Chapter 20
Maintain Teller Branch Parameters
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Branch Maintenance, click
Teller Branch Parameters Maintenance or specify Teller Branch Parameters
Maintenance in the search icon bar and select the screen.
The Teller Branch Parameters Maintenance summary screen is displayed.
3. On the Teller Branch Parameters Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For
more information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Code Select the branch code from the list of the available options.
Description Displays the description of the branch.
20-4
Chapter 20
Maintain Branch Role Limits
Field Description
Denomination Tracking Specify the denomination that needs to be tracked for the
Required Vault, Till and Vault, or None. The descriptions of the drop-
down values are given below:
• Till and Vault - To track denomination for Tills and Vault.
By default, this option is selected.
• Vault - To track denomination only for Vault, if a Vault is
involved in the transaction.
• None - To indicate that denomination tracking is not
required for any transaction.
Currency Code Displays the currency for which the Minimum Cash Holding
Limit or Maximum Cash Holding Limit is to be maintained
for the branch.
Minimum Cash Holding Displays the minimum cash holding limit for the branch.
Limit
Maximum Cash Holding Displays the maximum cash holding limit for the branch.
Limit
Note:
The maximum cash holding amount must not be
less than the minimum cash holding amount.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured teller branch parameters.
20-5
Chapter 20
Maintain Branch Role Limits
20-6
Chapter 20
Maintain Branch User Preferences
3. On the Branch Role Limits Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Role ID Select the role ID for which the limit preferences are to be set.
Role Description Displays the role description for the selected Role ID.
Supervisor Role Select if the defined role is a designated supervisor of the branch
who has the authorization rights.
Limit Currency Select the currency code in which the limits are to be specified.
Input Limit Specify the transaction input limit for a single transaction.
Authorization Limit Specify the maximum amount that the role is allowed to process
while authorizing a transaction.
Action Click the necessary icon to edit, save, or delete a row.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured branch role limits.
20-7
Chapter 20
Maintain Branch User Preferences
3. On the User Preferences screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Code Click the search icon, and select the branch code from the list
of values.
User ID Click the search icon, and select the user ID for which the
branch preferences are to be maintained.
Till/Vault Indicator Select from the following drop-down values:
• Till
• Vault
• Both
• None
20-8
Chapter 20
Maintain Denominations
Field Description
Shortage/Overage GL Note:
Currently not used, meant for future use.
Carry Forward Allowed Select if the funds are allowed to carry forward for the next day.
Inter Branch Select if the transfer between the branches is allowed.
Transactions Allowed
Receive Email Select if the Teller needs to receive emails for approval of
transactions.
Receive Notification Select if the Teller needs to receive notifications in Dashboard.
Currency Holding Specify the fields.
Preferences
Currency Code Click the search icon, and select the currency code to specify
the cash holding preferences.
Minimum Balance Specify the minimum balance to be maintained for the Till or
Vault.
Maximum Balance Specify the maximum balance to be maintained for the Till or
Vault.
Currency Limit Specify the fields.
Preferences
Currency Code Click the search icon, and select the currency in which the
limits (transactions amounts) will be expressed.
Max Transaction Specify the maximum transaction amount allowed that the user
Amount can enter in a single transaction.
Authorization Limit Specify the maximum amount that the user (to which the limit
role is associated) is allowed to process while authorizing a
transaction.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured user preferences.
20-9
Chapter 20
Maintain Denominations
To maintain denominations:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Branch Maintenance, click
Denominations Maintenance or specify Denominations Maintenance in the
search icon bar and select the screen.
The Denominations Maintenance summary screen is displayed.
20-10
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Definitions
3. On the Denomination Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Currency Code Specify the currency for which the currency denomination is to be
maintained.
Currency Description Specify the description of the currency code.
Denomination Type Select the denomination type.
Denomination Details Specify the fields.
Denomination ID Specify the denomination code.
Description Specify the description of the denomination code.
Value Specify the numeric value of the denomination code.
Sequence Number Specify the number such that the denomination codes will be
displayed in the same sequence maintained.
Type Specify the type as Coin or Note.
Large Denomination Select if a particular denomination is to be maintained as a large
denomination.
Add Click Add to add the specified denomination details as an entry to
the table.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured denominations.
20-11
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Definitions
Note:
In Function Code Definition screen, reversal allowed flag will not be
enabled for BC Payment Reversal, DD Payment Reversal, and Cash
Remittance Reversal. The system displays an error message stating that
the Reversal is not supported, making reversal allowed as N.
3. On the Function Code Definition screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-12
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Definitions
Field Description
Function Code Select from the list function codes that are factory shipped. For the
list of function codes and the respective screen names, refer to List
of Function Codes.
Function Code Displays the description of the function code.
Description
Transaction Limit Specify the maximum transaction amount allowed for this function
code in branch currency.
Support Child Function Select if the specified function code needs to act as the parent
Code function code.
Parent Function Code Specify the applicable parent function code.
Note:
This field is enabled only if the Support Child Function
Code is not selected.
Next Date Transaction Select if the next day transaction posting needs to be allowed for the
Allowed specified function code.
Charge Details Specify the fields.
Apply Charges Specify if charges are applicable for this transaction.
Exchange Rate Details Specify the fields.
Rate Type Select the rate type for the transaction code.
Rate Code Select the rate code for the transaction code.
Override Limit Specify the override limit. The system displays the default override
limit currency as GBP.
Stop Limit Specify the stop limit. The system displays the default stop-limit
currency as GBP.
Additional Preferences Specify the fields.
Reversal Allowed Specify if the reversal is allowed for the transaction.
Note:
Reversal allowed will be disabled for remittances and
clearing transactions. Hence, reversal will not be enabled
in the journal log.
20-13
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Definitions
Field Description
Input Slip Confirmation Select if the input slip confirmation is required for the transaction. If
this option is selected for a transaction screen, the Input-Slip button
will be displayed on the screen.
On the specified transaction screens, you can click Input-Slip to
view the input slip before transaction submission. Once you click
Input-Slip, the system validates mandatory fields. In addition, you
can perform any of the following actions:
• Confirm and Print – This icon is enabled only if Input Slip
Confirmation is selected in the Function Code Definition
screen. In addition, the transaction can be submitted only if the
receipt is confirmed. Click this button to confirm and print the
receipt.
• Print – Click Print to print the generated slip and provide it to
the customer.
• Close – Click Close to close the generated receipt.
Note:
If the mandatory fields are not filled, the system shows
an error message Value is required, wherever
applicable.
Transaction Alert Select the alert notification preference from the drop-down list. The
Preference values are mentioned below:
• SMS – the system sends an SMS notification of the
transactions to the registered mobile number of the customer.
• Email – the system sends an email notification of the
transactions to the registered email ID of the customer.
• Both – the system sends SMS and email notifications of the
transactions to the registered mobile number and email ID of
the customer.
• None – the system will not send any notifications to the
customer.
Note:
The setup for Plato alerts needs to be completed and
Kafka topics need to be created to enable e-mail alerts.
For information on setup, refer to Oracle Banking Branch
Installation Guide.
Advices This section allows selecting advice for multiple Function Codes.
Advice Name Displays the advice name.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured function code definitions.
20-14
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Preferences
The approval needs to be provided by the roles configured with AND or OR condition defined
either in the primary authorization path or in the alternate authorization path. Based on the
sample values provided, the following are some possible scenarios for multi-level
authorization:
20-15
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Preferences
20-16
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Preferences
3. On the Function Code Preferences screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-17
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Preferences
Field Description
Branch Code Select the branch code from the list of values.
Note:
The list of values should have the *.* for the "All"
option.
Note:
This is mandatory only if the Teller Sequence
Request is selected.
Note:
Assignment mode to be defined as 'Auto' if Rule
based auth flag is selected.
20-18
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Preferences
Field Description
Email Approval Select if authorization through email is required for a
Required transaction.
Note:
If this option is selected in override confirmation,
then an email will be sent as per the assignment
mode maintained. This email will be sent to the
selected approver or a list of approvers associated
with the role maintained. The approvers will get an
email for authorization only if receive email flag is
selected in the User Preferences screen. Once the
email is received, Approver can either approve or
reject the transaction. When you click the Approve
or Reject, an email will be automatically opened in
the system where the approver can type their
comments. The setup for Plato alerts needs to be
completed and Kafka topics need to be created to
enable e-mail alerts. For information on setup, refer
to Oracle Banking Branch Installation Guide.
Signature Verification Select if the Teller needs to verify the customer’s signature
Required while submitting the transaction.
Authorization Specify the fields.
Preferences
Authorization required Select if the authorization is required for the inter-branch
for Interbranch transaction.
Transaction
Authorization required Select if the authorization is required in case you have
for Charge Amendment amended the charge defaulted by the system.
Authorization required Select if the authorization is required in case you have
for Exchange Rate amended the exchange rate defaulted by the system.
Amendment
Authorization required Select if the authorization is required by default for the
by Default transaction.
Assignment Mode Select to indicate whether remote authorization assignment is
the automatic or manual operation for the transaction.
Authorizer Role Select the role of the authorizers. The users belonging to this
role are the valid authorizers for this workflow.
Note:
This field is applicable, if assignment mode is
Manual or if assignment mode is Auto and no
default authorizer is maintained for the user.
20-19
Chapter 20
Maintain Function Code Preferences
Field Description
Rule-Based Specify the fields. This segment can be used to configure
Authorization multi-level authorization of the preferences with the use of
Supervisor Role ID and Alternate Supervisor Role ID fields.
Note:
Rule Based Authorization cannot be applied for
customer servicing transactions.
4. Click Save.
20-20
Chapter 20
Maintain Default Authorizer
The summary view is displayed with the configured function code preferences.
3. On the Default Authorizer screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-21
Chapter 20
Maintain Accounting and Settlements
Field Description
User ID Select the user ID from the list of values. The list consists of
user IDs for which a default authorizer needs to be maintained.
User Name Displays the name of the user, when you select the user ID.
Branch Code Select the branch code from the list of values. This field is
enabled if the All option is selected in the User ID field.
Note:
If a specific authorizer is selected, then the system
will default the home branch as branch code.
Branch Name Displays the branch name, when you select the Branch Code.
Default Authorizer Select the default authorizer from the list of values, if it is
already set while assigning the transaction. If the mode
assigned is Manual, it allows changing the default authorizer.
Select the authorizer ID from the adjoining option list. The
options list consists of authorizers who are mapped to a role
with Savings Authorizer flag value as Y or All option.
Description Displays the description.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured default authorizer.
20-22
Chapter 20
Maintain Accounting and Settlements
3. On the Accounting Settlement screen, specify the fields. For more information on fields,
refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Select the branch for which the accounting details need to be
defined from the list of values.
Note:
The value *.* indicates the "All" option.
Currency Select the currency for which the accounting details need to be
defined from the list of values.
Note:
The value *.* indicates the "All" option.
Function Code Select the function code for which the accounting details need to be
defined from the list of values.
20-23
Chapter 20
Maintain Accounting and Settlements
Field Description
Function Code Displays the description of the selected function code.
Description
Transaction Account Select the transaction account or GL from the list of values. The list
of values displays all valid GLs maintained. This field is kept blank if
the transaction account needs to be selected from the transaction
screen.
Note:
LOV query will fetch the Nostro type of accounts for 9009
and 9010 function codes. For other function codes, only
GL accounts will be fetched from LOV.
Offset Account/GL No Select the offset account or GL from the list of values. The list of
values displays all valid GLs maintained.
Note:
LOV query will fetch the Nostro type of accounts for 9009
and 9010 function codes. For other function codes, only
GL accounts will be fetched from LOV.
Transaction Code for Select the transaction code used for debit accounting from the list of
Debit values.
Transaction Code for Select the transaction code used for credit accounting from the list
Credit of values.
Main Leg Accounting Select to pass the main accounting entries along with the charges
Required defined in the transaction code.
Note:
This field is used during accounting only when the
transaction involves negotiated exchange rate.
20-24
Chapter 20
Maintain Instrument Numbers
Field Description
Loss Reval GL Specify the loss revaluation GL details.
Note:
This field is used during accounting only when the
transaction involves negotiated exchange rate.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured accounting details.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-25
Chapter 20
Maintain Inter Branch Transit Account
Field Description
Instrument Type Specify the instrument type for which the instrument
maintenance needs to be done.
Branch Select the branch code from the list of values.
Generate Instrument Specify Generate Instrument Number as Yes/No by selecting
Number the radio-button.
• If Yes, then Instrument number will be generated by
OBBRN.
• If No, then Instrument number will be generated by
OBPM.
Cheque Number Specify the cheque number for which the instrument
maintenance needs to be done.
Number of Leaves Specify the number of leaves.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured instrument number.
20-26
Chapter 20
Maintain Inter Branch Transit Account
3. On the Inter Branch Transit Account Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Code Select the branch code from the list of values, which provides all the
branch codes maintained in the system.
Branch Name Display the description of the selected branch code.
Receiving Branch Specify the destination branch to which the cash is transferred.
Branch Name Display the description of the selected Receiving Branch code.
Currency Specify the currency of the cash.
20-27
Chapter 20
Maintain External System
Table 20-17 (Cont.) Inter Branch Transit Account Maintenance - Field Description
Field Description
Transit Account Specify the transit account that is used to track the movement of
cash.
Action Click the necessary icon to edit, save, or delete a row.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured inter-branch transit account.
20-28
Chapter 20
Maintain External System
3. On the External System Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
External System Code Specify the system code of the registered external system.
External System Name Specify the name of the registered external system.
Function Code Specify the function code of the transaction, which needs to be
performed through the external system. You can also select from
the list of values.
On Warning Select from the drop-down list. The values in the drop-down list are
mentioned below:
• Ignore – Select if you need to ignore the override raised and
process the transaction until completion.
• Error – Select if you need to show the error message and stop
the transaction.
On Approval Select from the drop-down list. The values in the drop-down list are
mentioned below:
• Ignore – Select if you need to ignore the override raised and
process the transaction until completion.
• Error – Select if you need to show the error message and stop
the transaction.
Incoming User Type Select the incoming user type from the drop-down values. The
values in the drop-down list are mentioned below:
• User – User appearing in the payload to process the
transaction.
• Default User – Default user that is maintained to process the
transaction.
• Role – Role appearing in the payload to process the
transaction.
• Default Role – Default role that is maintained to process the
transaction.
Default User Specify the default user maintained.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Incoming User Type is
selected as Default User.
20-29
Chapter 20
Maintain Channel Limits
Field Description
Default Role Specify the default role maintained.
Note:
This field is applicable only if the Incoming User Type is
selected as Default Role.
External Initiation Select if you need to log the transaction into Journal Log with the
status Initiated.
Till Update Select if you need to update the Till.
Authorization required by Select if you need to raise an override even if it is N in function
Default preference.
Action Click the necessary icon to edit, save, or delete a row.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of external system
maintenance.
20-30
Chapter 20
Maintain Channel Limits
3. On the Channel Limits Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Group Click the search icon and select account group from the list of
values.
Note:
The list of values provides the account groups that are
maintained in the Account Group Maintenance screen.
Note:
By default, the value is selected as Branch.
4. Click Save.
20-31
Chapter 20
Maintain Account Group
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of channel limits
maintenance.
3. On the Account Group Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-32
Chapter 20
Maintain Branch Group
Field Description
Account Group Code Specify the account group code.
Account Group Code Specify the description of the account group code.
Description
Add Accounts Specify the fields.
Account Number Specify the account number. You can also select from the list of
values.
Account Name Displays the description for the specified account number.
Reset Click Reset to reset the accounts added.
Add Accounts Click Add Accounts to add the account specified.
Accounts Added Displays the details of accounts added to the table. Once you add
an account to the table, you can click the necessary icon to edit or
delete the added entry.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of account groups.
20-33
Chapter 20
Maintain Customer Group
3. On the Branch Group Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Branch Group Code Specify the branch group code.
Branch Group Code Specify the description of the branch group code.
Description
Add Accounts Specify the fields.
Branch Number Specify the branch number. You can also select from the list of
values.
Branch Name Displays the description for the specified branch number.
Reset Click Reset to reset the branches added.
Add Branch Click Add Branch to add the branch specified.
Branches Added Displays the details of branches added in the table. Once you
add a branch in the table, you can click the necessary icon to
edit or delete the added entry.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of branch groups.
20-34
Chapter 20
Maintain Customer Group
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Branch Maintenance, click
Customer Group Maintenance or specify Customer Group Maintenance in the search
icon bar and select the screen.
The Customer Group Maintenance summary screen is displayed.
3. On the Customer Group Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Customer Group Code Specify the customer group code.
Customer Group Code Specify the description of the customer group code.
Description
20-35
Chapter 20
Maintain Charge Definitions
Field Description
Customer Number Specify the customer number. You can also select from the list of
values.
Note:
You cannot add the same customer number in two
different groups.
Customer Name Displays the description for the specified customer number.
Reset Click Reset to reset the customer numbers added.
Add Customer Click Add Customer to add the customer numbers specified.
Customers Added Displays the details of customer numbers added to the table. Once
you add a customer number to the table, you can click the
necessary icon to edit or delete the added entry.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of customer groups.
20-36
Chapter 20
Maintain Charge Definitions
3. On the Charge Definition Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Charge Code Specify the charge code.
Charge Description Specify the description of the charge code.
Charge Category Select the charge category (Standard or Tax).
Charge Credit Account Specify the charge credit account for the transaction. You can also
select the GL from the list of values or the DR_LEG/CR_LEG.
Note:
If DR_LEG/CR_LEG is selected, the corresponding debit/
credit account of the transaction will be considered for
the charge processing. For example, if the charge code is
defined with Charge Debit Account as DR_LEG for a
cash deposit function code, the charge will be collected
from cash GL. Hence, the customer is expected to
deposit cash including the charge amount. For such a
charge code, the Charge by Cash field will be displayed
as Yes in the charges data segment of the transaction
screen.
20-37
Chapter 20
Create Charge Pricing Maintenance
Field Description
Charge Debit Account Specify the charge debit account for the transaction. You can also
select the GL from the list of values or the DR_LEG/CR_LEG.
Note:
If DR_LEG/CR_LEG is selected, the corresponding debit/
credit account of the transaction will be considered for
the charge processing. For example, if the charge code is
defined with Charge Debit Account as DR_LEG for a
cash deposit function code, the charge will be collected
from cash GL. Hence, the customer is expected to
deposit cash including the charge amount. For such a
charge code, the Charge by Cash field will be displayed
as Yes in the charges data segment of the transaction
screen.
Credit Txn Code Click the search icon and select the credit transaction code from the
list of values.
Debit Txn Code Click the search icon and select the debit transaction code from the
list of values.
Pricing Source System Specify the pricing source system. You can also select from the list
of values.
Pricing Source Displays the description of the pricing source.
Description
EDE Code Displays the details of charge codes added to the table. Once you
add a customer number to the table, you can click the necessary
icon to edit or delete the added entry.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of charge definitions.
20-38
Chapter 20
Create Charge Pricing Maintenance
2. On the Create Charge Pricing Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Application Code Specify the application code.
Charge Pricing Specify the description of the charge pricing.
Description
Pricing Category Select the pricing category. The drop-down list has the following
values:
• Fixed Amount
• Fixed Percent
• Tier Based Amount
• Tier Based Percent
Pricing Method Select the pricing method. The drop-down values will vary based on
the Pricing Category.
Pricing Currency Select the pricing currency.
Rate Code Click the search icon and select the rate code from the list of values.
Rate Type Select the rate type from the drop-down values.
Charge in Transaction Select if the charges are needed in the transaction currency.
Currency
Min/Max Validation Select the criteria (Amount or Percentage) for minimum or
Criteria maximum validation.
20-39
Chapter 20
View Charge Pricing Maintenance
Field Description
Min Charge Amount/ Specify the minimum charge amount or percent.
Percent
Note:
Based on the value selected in the Min/Max Validation
Criteria, this field gets enabled.
Note:
Based on the value selected in the Min/Max Validation
Criteria, this field gets enabled.
Fixed Amount/Percent Specify the fixed amount or percent. This field is enabled only if
Pricing Category is selected as Fixed Amount or Fixed Percent.
3. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of charge pricing.
You can view a summary of the configured records for the charge pricing details on
this screen.
20-40
Chapter 20
Maintain Charge Condition Group
3. On the Charge Condition Group Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
20-41
Chapter 20
Maintain Charge Condition Group
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Charge Condition Specify the charge group code.
Group Code
Charge Condition Specify the description of the charge group code.
Group Code
Description
Parameter 1 to Select the parameters 1 to 5. For more information on
Parameter 5 Parameters, refer to Additional Information on Parameters.
Charge Details Specify the fields.
Value 1 to Value 5 Specify the values 1 to 5. You can also select from the list of
values.
Charge Pricing Rule ID Specify the charge pricing rule ID. You can also select from the
list of values.
Charge Pricing Rule Displays the description for specified charge pricing rule ID.
Description
Reset Click Reset to reset the charge group details added.
Add Charge Group Click Add Charge Group to add the charge group details
specified.
Charge Groups Added Displays the details of charge groups added to the table. Once
you add a customer number to the table, you can click the
necessary icon to edit or delete the added entry.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured groups of the charge condition
codes.
• Additional Information on Parameters
The Parameters field on the Charge Condition Group Maintenance screen
needs to be selected based on the specified conditions.
20-42
Chapter 20
Maintain Charge Decisions
{
"UtilityProvider": "$.institutionID",
"P2": "",
"P3": "",
"P4": "",
"P5": ""
}
For the other options in Parameter field, the JSON needs to be updated as follows:
Option Value
Account Group "AccountGroup": ""
Customer Group "CustomerGroup": ""
Transaction Branch Group "TransactionBranchGroup": ""
To Account Branch Group "ToAccountBranchGroup": ""
To Account Branch "ToAccountBranch": "$.toAccountBranch"
<$.toAccountBranch has to be replaced with the
field id as per the FID that captures To
Account Branch>
Account Currency "AccCcy": "$.AccCcy"
<$.AccCcy has to be replaced with the field id
as per the FID that captures Account Currency>
Utility Provider "UtilityProvider": "$.institutionID"
<$.institutionID has to be replaced with the
field id as per the FID that captures Utility
Provider>
20-43
Chapter 20
Maintain Charge Decisions
3. On the Charge Decision Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Function Code Specify the function code. You can also select from the list of
values.
Branch Specify the branch code. You can also select from the list of
values.
Currency Specify the currency code. You can also select from the list of
values.
20-44
Chapter 20
Charge Decision Enquiry
Field Description
Inter Branch Select the inter-branch requirement from the following drop-
down values:
• Yes
• No
• Both
Charge Details Specify the fields.
Charge Code Specify the charge code. You can also select from the list of
values.
Charge Description Displays the description of the charge code specified.
Charge Pricing Rule ID Specify the charge-pricing rule ID. You can also select from the
list of values.
Note:
You can choose the pricing rule ID to apply charge
or choose a group code from which the pricing rule
will be picked for calculation. You can only define
the rule or group. Either the rule can be used, or a
group can be used.
Charge Pricing Rule Displays the description of the charge-pricing rule ID specified.
Description
Charge Basis Specify the charge basis. You can also select from the list of
values.
Charge Condition Specify the charge condition group.
Group
Reset Click Reset to reset the charges added.
Add Charges Click Add Charges to add the charge decisions specified.
Charges Added Displays the details of charge decisions added to the table.
Once you add an account to the table, you can click the
necessary icon to edit or delete the added entry.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of charge decisions.
20-45
Chapter 20
Charge Decision Enquiry
2. On the Charge Decision Enquiry screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Function Code Click the search icon and select function code from the list of
values.
Branch Click the search icon and select branch code from the list of
values.
20-46
Chapter 20
Maintain Reject Codes
Field Description
Currency Click the search icon and select currency code from the list of
values.
Inter Branch Select the value for inter-branch from the drop-down list.
Fetch Click Fetch to fetch the details based on the specified search
criteria.
Charge Code Displays the charge code.
Charge Pricing Rule ID Displays the charge pricing rule ID.
Charge Basis Displays the charge basis.
Charge Condition Displays the charge condition group.
Group
Charge Definition Displays the charge definition details. For information on fields
refer to Maintain Charge Definitions.
Charge Pricing Displays the charge pricing details. For information on fields
refer to Create Charge Pricing Maintenance.
20-47
Chapter 20
Maintain Clearing Network Codes
3. On the Reject Code Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Reject Code Specify the reject code. This code indicates the reason for
rejecting a clearing transaction.
Reject Code Specify the description of the reject code.
Description
Applicable For Select from the radio list from the following drop-down values:
• Inward Return
• Outward Return
• Both Inward and Outward Return
• Inhouse Cheques
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of reject codes.
20-48
Chapter 20
Maintain Clearing Network Codes
3. On the Clearing Network Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information
on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Clearing Network Code Specify the clearing network code.
Clearing Network Specify the description of the clearing network code.
Description
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of network codes.
20-49
Chapter 20
Maintain Denomination Variations
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-50
Chapter 20
Maintain External Bank Codes
Field Description
Currency 1 Select the currency from the list of values.
Currency 2 Displays the currency 2.
Maintenance Country Displays the maintenance country.
Rate Type Select the rate type from the list of values.
Denomination ID Select the denomination ID from the list of values.
Buy Variance Specify the buy variance.
Sell Variance Specify the sell variance.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of denomination-wise
variations.
20-51
Chapter 20
Maintain Issuer Codes
3. On the External Bank Code screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Bank Code Specify the bank code.
Bank Name Specify the name of the bank.
Branch Code Specify the branch code.
Branch Name Specify the branch name.
Branch Address 1 to Specify the address of the branch.
Branch Address 4
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of external bank and
branch codes.
20-52
Chapter 20
Maintain Utility Providers
3. On the Issuer Code Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more information on
fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Issuer Code Specify the issuer code.
Issuer Code Description Specify the description of the issuer code.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of issuer codes.
20-53
Chapter 20
Maintain Utility Providers
• Water
To maintain utility providers:
1. On the Homepage, from Teller mega menu, under Branch Maintenance, click
Utility Provider Maintenance or specify Utility Provider Maintenance in the
search icon bar and select the screen.
The Utility Provider Maintenance summary screen is displayed.
3. On the Utility Provider Maintenance screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
20-54
Chapter 20
Maintain Account Entitlement Restriction
Field Description
Provider ID Click the search icon, and select the provider ID from the list of
values.
Provider Description Specify the description of the utility provider.
Provider Settlement Click the search icon, and select the provider settlement account
Account from the list of values.
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of utility providers.
20-55
Chapter 20
Maintain Account Entitlement Restriction
3. On the Account Entitlement Restriction screen, specify the fields. For more
information on fields, refer to the field description table.
Note:
The fields, which are marked with an asterisk, are mandatory.
Field Description
Account Entitlement Click search icon, and select the account entitlement code
Code from the list of values.
Restriction Type Select restriction type from the radio list from the following
drop-down values:
• Allowed
• Disallowed
Function Code Details Specify the fields.
Function Code Click search icon, and select the function code from the list of
values.
Function Code Displays the description of the function code.
Description
4. Click Save.
The summary view is displayed with the configured details of utility providers.
20-56
A
Error Codes and Messages
The error codes and messages that are available for the Oracle Banking Branch application
are provided in this appendix. The error codes with the prefix GCS apply only to the
maintenance screens, and the remaining error codes apply to all the transaction screens.
A-1
Appendix A
A-2
Appendix A
A-3
Appendix A
A-4
Appendix A
A-5
Appendix A
A-6
Appendix A
A-7
Appendix A
A-8
Appendix A
A-9
Appendix A
A-10
Appendix A
A-11
B
List of Function Codes
The list of function codes and their respective names for all the transaction screens of the
Oracle Banking Branch application are provided in this appendix.
B-1
Appendix B
B-2
Appendix B
B-3
Appendix B
B-4
C
Advices
The formats of various advices that are available for the Oracle Banking Branch application
are provided in this appendix.
Topics
• Account Transfer
• Cash Deposit
• Cash Withdrawal
• Cheque Deposit
• Cheque Withdrawal
• DD Issue Against Account
• Domestic Transfer Against Account
Account Transfer
The advice format for Account Transfer transactions is given below:
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
Cash Deposit
The advice format for Cash Deposit transactions is given below:
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
C-1
Appendix C
-----------------------------------------------------------------
Teller Officer/Manager
Cash Withdrawal
The advice format for Cash Withdrawal transactions is given below:
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
Teller Officer/Manager
Cheque Deposit
The advice format for Cheque Deposit transactions is given below:
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
Receipt #txnRefNumber
----------------------------------------------------------------------
txnDate txnBranchCode, Clinton Branch
----------------------------------------------------------------------
Transaction : functionCodeDesc
Sequence Number : tellerSeqNumber
Account Number : toAccountNumber
Cheque Number : chequeNumber
C-2
Appendix C
Cheque Withdrawal
The advice format for Cheque Withdrawal transactions is given below:
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
TRANSACTION RECEIPT
C-3
Appendix C
Receipt # txnRefNumber
----------------------------------------------------------------------
Transaction : functionCodeDesc
Sequence Number : txnSeqNumber
Account Number : fromAccountNumber
Beneficiary Bank : bankDesc
Beneficiary Name : txnCustomer
Clearing Type : FEDWIRE
Transfer Amount : fromAccountAmt fromAccountCcy
Commission Charges : totalCharges fromAccountCcy
Narrative : narrative
Teller ID : userId
----------------------------------------------------------------------
(This slip do not require signature)
C-4
D
Order of Replacing Parameters with Wild
Card Entries
The order of replacing parameters with wild card entries is required for the Accounting and
Settlements Definition and Charge Decision Maintenance.
D-1
Appendix D
D-2
E
Static Maintenance Parameters
The descriptions for the column names of the significant parameters in the static
maintenance tables are provided in this appendix. If required, the user needs to modify these
parameters in the respective static maintenance tables.
Note:
When the value is set to N, the
Exchange Rate fields will be hidden.
Note:
This flag applies only to the function
codes – 8004, 8203, 8206, and 8207.
IS_NEGOTIATED_RATE_EN This column indicates whether the Negotiated Exchange Rate field is
ABLED required on the screen or not. The user can modify this flag to enable/
disable the Negotiated Exchange Rate for a specified screen.
Possible values are as follows:
• Y – Yes
• N – No
IS_REVERSAL_SUPP This column indicates whether the transaction reversal is supported or
not. The user can modify this flag to enable/disable the reversal for a
particular transaction. Possible values are as follows:
• Y – Yes
• N – No
E-1
Appendix E
E-2
Index
A C
Account Address Update, 18-19 Cash Deposit, 4-2
Account Balance Inquiry, 18-13 Cash Deposit (Teller Session), 14-1
Account Entitlement Restriction, 20-55 Cash Remittance Issue Against Account, 8-99
Account Group Maintenance, 20-32 Cash Remittance Issue Against Cash, 8-103
Account Statement Request, 18-16 Cash Remittance Issue Against GL, 8-106
Account to Account Transfer, 6-1 Cash Remittance Operations - Cancel by
Alerts, 19-7 Account, 8-130
Cash Remittance Operations - Cancel by Cash,
8-133
B Cash Remittance Operations - Cancel by GL,
BC Issue Against Account, 8-2 8-136
BC Issue Against GL, 8-10 Cash Remittance Operations - Inquiry, 8-110
BC Issue Against Walk-in, 8-6 Cash Remittance Operations - Payment by
BC Operations - Cancel by Account, 8-39 Account, 8-113
BC Operations - Cancel by Cash, 8-42 Cash Remittance Operations - Payment by Cash,
BC Operations - Cancel by GL, 8-44 8-116
BC Operations - Duplicate Issue, 8-21 Cash Remittance Operations - Payment by GL,
BC Operations - Inquiry, 8-16 8-118
BC Operations - Payment by Account, 8-25 Cash Remittance Operations - Refund by
BC Operations - Payment by Cash, 8-27 Account, 8-122
BC Operations - Payment by GL, 8-30 Cash Remittance Operations - Refund by Cash,
BC Operations - Payment Reversal, 8-23 8-124
BC Operations - Refund by Account, 8-32 Cash Remittance Operations - Refund by GL,
BC Operations - Refund by Cash, 8-35 8-127
BC Operations - Refund by GL, 8-37 Cash Withdrawal, 4-7
BC Operations - Revalidate, 8-19 Cash Withdrawal (Teller Session), 14-2
BC Print-Reprint, 8-14 Channel Limits Maintenance, 20-30
Bill Payment by Account, 13-3 Charge Condition Group Maintenance, 20-41
Bill Payment by Cash, 13-1 Charge Decision Enquiry, 20-45
Bill Payment by Clearing Cheque, 13-6 Charge Decision Maintenance, 20-43
Book Overage, 2-24 Charge Definition Maintenance, 20-36
Book Shortage, 2-21 Cheque Book Request, 18-4
Branch Breach Limits, 2-10 Cheque Book Status Change, 18-22
Branch Group Maintenance, 20-33 Cheque Deposit Against Account, 7-1
Branch Role Limits, 20-5 Cheque Deposit Against GL, 7-5
Branch Total Position, 2-12 Cheque Return, 7-8
Branch User Limits, 20-7 Cheque Status Inquiry, 18-2
Buy Cash from Currency Chest, 3-11 Cheque Withdrawal, 4-11
Buy Cash from Till, 3-17 Clear Cache, 17-1
Buy Cash from Vault, 3-14 Clearing Network, 20-48
Buy TC from Agent, 3-2 Close Branch Batch, 2-20
Buy TC from Head Office, 3-4 Close Out Withdrawal, 4-28
Buy TC from Vault, 3-5 Close Out Withdrawal by Multi Mode, 4-35
Index-1
Index
F N
F23 Tax Payment by Account, 4-64 Notifications, 19-5
F23C Tax Payment by Cash, 4-43
F24 Tax Payment By Account, 4-69
F24C Tax Payment By Cash, 4-47
Frequent Branch Operations, 19-4
Index-2
Index
S U
Safe Deposit Rental By Cash, 4-38 Utility Provider Maintenance, 20-53
Sell Cash to Currency Chest, 3-13
Sell Cash to Till, 3-18 V
Sell Cash to Vault, 3-15
Servicing Journal, 15-7 View Charge Pricing Maintenance, 20-40
Settlements Definition, 20-22
Index-3